Merge reload-branch up to revision 101000
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / config / frv / frv.c
blobb54c085858dea85f6cb92759f4e38b525d28407b
1 /* Copyright (C) 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005
2 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Red Hat, Inc.
5 This file is part of GCC.
7 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "rtl.h"
27 #include "tree.h"
28 #include "regs.h"
29 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
30 #include "real.h"
31 #include "insn-config.h"
32 #include "conditions.h"
33 #include "insn-flags.h"
34 #include "output.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 #include "flags.h"
37 #include "recog.h"
38 #include "reload.h"
39 #include "expr.h"
40 #include "obstack.h"
41 #include "except.h"
42 #include "function.h"
43 #include "optabs.h"
44 #include "toplev.h"
45 #include "basic-block.h"
46 #include "tm_p.h"
47 #include "ggc.h"
48 #include <ctype.h>
49 #include "target.h"
50 #include "target-def.h"
51 #include "targhooks.h"
52 #include "integrate.h"
53 #include "langhooks.h"
55 #ifndef FRV_INLINE
56 #define FRV_INLINE inline
57 #endif
59 /* The maximum number of distinct NOP patterns. There are three:
60 nop, fnop and mnop. */
61 #define NUM_NOP_PATTERNS 3
63 /* Classification of instructions and units: integer, floating-point/media,
64 branch and control. */
65 enum frv_insn_group { GROUP_I, GROUP_FM, GROUP_B, GROUP_C, NUM_GROUPS };
67 /* The DFA names of the units, in packet order. */
68 static const char *const frv_unit_names[] =
70 "c",
71 "i0", "f0",
72 "i1", "f1",
73 "i2", "f2",
74 "i3", "f3",
75 "b0", "b1"
78 /* The classification of each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
79 static const enum frv_insn_group frv_unit_groups[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)] =
81 GROUP_C,
82 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
83 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
84 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
85 GROUP_I, GROUP_FM,
86 GROUP_B, GROUP_B
89 /* Return the DFA unit code associated with the Nth unit of integer
90 or floating-point group GROUP, */
91 #define NTH_UNIT(GROUP, N) frv_unit_codes[(GROUP) + (N) * 2 + 1]
93 /* Return the number of integer or floating-point unit UNIT
94 (1 for I1, 2 for F2, etc.). */
95 #define UNIT_NUMBER(UNIT) (((UNIT) - 1) / 2)
97 /* The DFA unit number for each unit in frv_unit_names[]. */
98 static int frv_unit_codes[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names)];
100 /* FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[T] is the last unit in frv_unit_names[] that can issue
101 an instruction of type T. The value is ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names) if
102 no instruction of type T has been seen. */
103 static unsigned int frv_type_to_unit[TYPE_UNKNOWN + 1];
105 /* An array of dummy nop INSNs, one for each type of nop that the
106 target supports. */
107 static GTY(()) rtx frv_nops[NUM_NOP_PATTERNS];
109 /* The number of nop instructions in frv_nops[]. */
110 static unsigned int frv_num_nops;
112 /* Return true if instruction INSN should be packed with the following
113 instruction. */
114 #define PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN) (GET_MODE (INSN) == TImode)
116 /* Set the value of PACKING_FLAG_P(INSN). */
117 #define SET_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, TImode)
118 #define CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG(INSN) PUT_MODE (INSN, VOIDmode)
120 /* Loop with REG set to each hard register in rtx X. */
121 #define FOR_EACH_REGNO(REG, X) \
122 for (REG = REGNO (X); \
123 REG < REGNO (X) + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO (X), GET_MODE (X)); \
124 REG++)
126 /* Temporary register allocation support structure. */
127 typedef struct frv_tmp_reg_struct
129 HARD_REG_SET regs; /* possible registers to allocate */
130 int next_reg[N_REG_CLASSES]; /* next register to allocate per class */
132 frv_tmp_reg_t;
134 /* Register state information for VLIW re-packing phase. */
135 #define REGSTATE_CC_MASK 0x07 /* Mask to isolate CCn for cond exec */
136 #define REGSTATE_MODIFIED 0x08 /* reg modified in current VLIW insn */
137 #define REGSTATE_IF_TRUE 0x10 /* reg modified in cond exec true */
138 #define REGSTATE_IF_FALSE 0x20 /* reg modified in cond exec false */
140 #define REGSTATE_IF_EITHER (REGSTATE_IF_TRUE | REGSTATE_IF_FALSE)
142 typedef unsigned char regstate_t;
144 /* Used in frv_frame_accessor_t to indicate the direction of a register-to-
145 memory move. */
146 enum frv_stack_op
148 FRV_LOAD,
149 FRV_STORE
152 /* Information required by frv_frame_access. */
153 typedef struct
155 /* This field is FRV_LOAD if registers are to be loaded from the stack and
156 FRV_STORE if they should be stored onto the stack. FRV_STORE implies
157 the move is being done by the prologue code while FRV_LOAD implies it
158 is being done by the epilogue. */
159 enum frv_stack_op op;
161 /* The base register to use when accessing the stack. This may be the
162 frame pointer, stack pointer, or a temporary. The choice of register
163 depends on which part of the frame is being accessed and how big the
164 frame is. */
165 rtx base;
167 /* The offset of BASE from the bottom of the current frame, in bytes. */
168 int base_offset;
169 } frv_frame_accessor_t;
171 /* Define the information needed to generate branch and scc insns. This is
172 stored from the compare operation. */
173 rtx frv_compare_op0;
174 rtx frv_compare_op1;
176 /* Conditional execution support gathered together in one structure. */
177 typedef struct
179 /* Linked list of insns to add if the conditional execution conversion was
180 successful. Each link points to an EXPR_LIST which points to the pattern
181 of the insn to add, and the insn to be inserted before. */
182 rtx added_insns_list;
184 /* Identify which registers are safe to allocate for if conversions to
185 conditional execution. We keep the last allocated register in the
186 register classes between COND_EXEC statements. This will mean we allocate
187 different registers for each different COND_EXEC group if we can. This
188 might allow the scheduler to intermix two different COND_EXEC sections. */
189 frv_tmp_reg_t tmp_reg;
191 /* For nested IFs, identify which CC registers are used outside of setting
192 via a compare isnsn, and using via a check insn. This will allow us to
193 know if we can rewrite the register to use a different register that will
194 be paired with the CR register controlling the nested IF-THEN blocks. */
195 HARD_REG_SET nested_cc_ok_rewrite;
197 /* Temporary registers allocated to hold constants during conditional
198 execution. */
199 rtx scratch_regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
201 /* Current number of temp registers available. */
202 int cur_scratch_regs;
204 /* Number of nested conditional execution blocks. */
205 int num_nested_cond_exec;
207 /* Map of insns that set up constants in scratch registers. */
208 bitmap scratch_insns_bitmap;
210 /* Conditional execution test register (CC0..CC7). */
211 rtx cr_reg;
213 /* Conditional execution compare register that is paired with cr_reg, so that
214 nested compares can be done. The csubcc and caddcc instructions don't
215 have enough bits to specify both a CC register to be set and a CR register
216 to do the test on, so the same bit number is used for both. Needless to
217 say, this is rather inconvenient for GCC. */
218 rtx nested_cc_reg;
220 /* Extra CR registers used for &&, ||. */
221 rtx extra_int_cr;
222 rtx extra_fp_cr;
224 /* Previous CR used in nested if, to make sure we are dealing with the same
225 nested if as the previous statement. */
226 rtx last_nested_if_cr;
228 frv_ifcvt_t;
230 static /* GTY(()) */ frv_ifcvt_t frv_ifcvt;
232 /* Map register number to smallest register class. */
233 enum reg_class regno_reg_class[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
235 /* Map class letter into register class. */
236 enum reg_class reg_class_from_letter[256];
238 /* Cached value of frv_stack_info. */
239 static frv_stack_t *frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
241 /* -mcpu= support */
242 frv_cpu_t frv_cpu_type = CPU_TYPE; /* value of -mcpu= */
244 /* Forward references */
246 static bool frv_handle_option (size_t, const char *, int);
247 static int frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void);
248 static int frv_string_begins_with (tree, const char *);
249 static FRV_INLINE bool frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx, int);
250 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg
251 (FILE *, rtx);
252 static void frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE *, rtx, int);
253 static int frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx);
254 static const char *comparison_string (enum rtx_code, rtx);
255 static FRV_INLINE int frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int, int);
256 static rtx single_set_pattern (rtx);
257 static int frv_function_contains_far_jump (void);
258 static rtx frv_alloc_temp_reg (frv_tmp_reg_t *,
259 enum reg_class,
260 enum machine_mode,
261 int, int);
262 static rtx frv_frame_offset_rtx (int);
263 static rtx frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode, rtx, int);
264 static rtx frv_dwarf_store (rtx, int);
265 static void frv_frame_insn (rtx, rtx);
266 static void frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
267 rtx, int);
268 static void frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t*,
269 frv_stack_t *, int);
270 static void frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op,
271 frv_stack_t *);
272 static struct machine_function *frv_init_machine_status (void);
273 static rtx frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
274 static enum machine_mode frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode);
275 static rtx frv_read_argument (tree *);
276 static rtx frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode, tree *);
277 static int frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
278 static rtx frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code, rtx);
279 static rtx frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code, int, rtx);
280 static rtx frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx, enum tls_model);
281 static rtx frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
282 static rtx frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
283 static rtx frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
284 static rtx frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
285 static rtx frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
286 static rtx frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
287 static rtx frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code, tree);
288 static rtx frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code, tree);
289 static rtx frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
290 static rtx frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
291 static rtx frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree);
292 static rtx frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
293 static rtx frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code, tree);
294 static rtx frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code);
295 static void frv_split_iacc_move (rtx, rtx);
296 static rtx frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
297 static int frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *, void *);
298 static void frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx, rtx, int);
299 static rtx frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx);
300 static rtx frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx, rtx);
301 static int frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *, void *);
302 static unsigned int frv_insn_unit (rtx);
303 static bool frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx);
304 static int frv_cond_flags (rtx);
305 static bool frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t, regstate_t);
306 static int frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *, void *);
307 static bool frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx);
308 static void frv_registers_update_1 (rtx, rtx, void *);
309 static void frv_registers_update (rtx);
310 static void frv_start_packet (void);
311 static void frv_start_packet_block (void);
312 static void frv_finish_packet (void (*) (void));
313 static bool frv_pack_insn_p (rtx);
314 static void frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx);
315 static void frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx);
316 static bool frv_for_each_packet (void (*) (void));
317 static bool frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group,
318 unsigned int, unsigned int,
319 unsigned int, unsigned int,
320 state_t);
321 static int frv_compare_insns (const void *, const void *);
322 static void frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group);
323 static void frv_reorder_packet (void);
324 static void frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group);
325 static void frv_align_label (void);
326 static void frv_reorg_packet (void);
327 static void frv_register_nop (rtx);
328 static void frv_reorg (void);
329 static void frv_pack_insns (void);
330 static void frv_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
331 static void frv_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
332 static bool frv_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned, int);
333 static void frv_init_builtins (void);
334 static rtx frv_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
335 static void frv_init_libfuncs (void);
336 static bool frv_in_small_data_p (tree);
337 static void frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
338 (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, tree);
339 static void frv_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *,
340 enum machine_mode,
341 tree, int *, int);
342 static rtx frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void);
343 static bool frv_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int*);
344 static void frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx, int);
345 static void frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx, int);
346 static bool frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx);
347 static bool frv_cannot_force_const_mem (rtx);
348 static const char *unspec_got_name (int);
349 static void frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *,
350 const struct frv_unspec *);
351 static bool frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
352 static rtx frv_struct_value_rtx (tree, int);
353 static bool frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, tree type);
354 static int frv_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
355 tree, bool);
356 static void frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *, int, rtx)
357 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
359 /* Allow us to easily change the default for -malloc-cc. */
360 #ifndef DEFAULT_NO_ALLOC_CC
361 #define MASK_DEFAULT_ALLOC_CC MASK_ALLOC_CC
362 #else
363 #define MASK_DEFAULT_ALLOC_CC 0
364 #endif
366 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
367 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
368 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE frv_function_prologue
369 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
370 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE frv_function_epilogue
371 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
372 #define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER frv_assemble_integer
373 #undef TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
374 #define TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS \
375 (MASK_DEFAULT_ALLOC_CC \
376 | MASK_COND_MOVE \
377 | MASK_SCC \
378 | MASK_COND_EXEC \
379 | MASK_VLIW_BRANCH \
380 | MASK_MULTI_CE \
381 | MASK_NESTED_CE)
382 #undef TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
383 #define TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION frv_handle_option
384 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
385 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS frv_init_builtins
386 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
387 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN frv_expand_builtin
388 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
389 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS frv_init_libfuncs
390 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
391 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P frv_in_small_data_p
392 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
393 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS frv_rtx_costs
394 #undef TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
395 #define TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_constructor
396 #undef TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
397 #define TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR frv_asm_out_destructor
399 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
400 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK frv_asm_output_mi_thunk
401 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
402 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
404 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
405 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE frv_issue_rate
407 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
408 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL frv_function_ok_for_sibcall
409 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
410 #define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM frv_cannot_force_const_mem
412 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
413 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
415 #undef TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
416 #define TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX frv_struct_value_rtx
417 #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
418 #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK frv_must_pass_in_stack
419 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
420 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE hook_pass_by_reference_must_pass_in_stack
421 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
422 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES frv_arg_partial_bytes
424 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
425 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS frv_expand_builtin_saveregs
426 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
427 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS frv_setup_incoming_varargs
428 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
429 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG frv_reorg
431 #if HAVE_AS_TLS
432 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
433 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL frv_output_dwarf_dtprel
434 #endif
436 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
438 #define FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P(RTX) \
439 (GET_CODE (RTX) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (RTX) != 0)
442 /* Any function call that satisfies the machine-independent
443 requirements is eligible on FR-V. */
445 static bool
446 frv_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
447 tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
449 return true;
452 /* Return true if SYMBOL is a small data symbol and relocation RELOC
453 can be used to access it directly in a load or store. */
455 static FRV_INLINE bool
456 frv_small_data_reloc_p (rtx symbol, int reloc)
458 return (GET_CODE (symbol) == SYMBOL_REF
459 && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (symbol)
460 && (!TARGET_FDPIC || flag_pic == 1)
461 && (reloc == R_FRV_GOTOFF12 || reloc == R_FRV_GPREL12));
464 /* Return true if X is a valid relocation unspec. If it is, fill in UNSPEC
465 appropriately. */
467 bool
468 frv_const_unspec_p (rtx x, struct frv_unspec *unspec)
470 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST)
472 unspec->offset = 0;
473 x = XEXP (x, 0);
474 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
476 unspec->offset += INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
477 x = XEXP (x, 0);
479 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_GOT)
481 unspec->symbol = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
482 unspec->reloc = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1));
484 if (unspec->offset == 0)
485 return true;
487 if (frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec->symbol, unspec->reloc)
488 && unspec->offset > 0
489 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) unspec->offset < g_switch_value)
490 return true;
493 return false;
496 /* Decide whether we can force certain constants to memory. If we
497 decide we can't, the caller should be able to cope with it in
498 another way.
500 We never allow constants to be forced into memory for TARGET_FDPIC.
501 This is necessary for several reasons:
503 1. Since LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P rejects constant pool addresses, the
504 target-independent code will try to force them into the constant
505 pool, thus leading to infinite recursion.
507 2. We can never introduce new constant pool references during reload.
508 Any such reference would require use of the pseudo FDPIC register.
510 3. We can't represent a constant added to a function pointer (which is
511 not the same as a pointer to a function+constant).
513 4. In many cases, it's more efficient to calculate the constant in-line. */
515 static bool
516 frv_cannot_force_const_mem (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
518 return TARGET_FDPIC;
521 /* Implement TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION. */
523 static bool
524 frv_handle_option (size_t code, const char *arg, int value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
526 switch (code)
528 case OPT_mcpu_:
529 if (strcmp (arg, "simple") == 0)
530 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_SIMPLE;
531 else if (strcmp (arg, "tomcat") == 0)
532 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_TOMCAT;
533 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr550") == 0)
534 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR550;
535 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr500") == 0)
536 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR500;
537 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr450") == 0)
538 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR450;
539 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr405") == 0)
540 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR405;
541 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr400") == 0)
542 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR400;
543 else if (strcmp (arg, "fr300") == 0)
544 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_FR300;
545 else if (strcmp (arg, "frv") == 0)
546 frv_cpu_type = FRV_CPU_GENERIC;
547 else
548 return false;
549 return true;
551 default:
552 return true;
556 static int
557 frv_default_flags_for_cpu (void)
559 switch (frv_cpu_type)
561 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
562 return MASK_DEFAULT_FRV;
564 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
565 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR550;
567 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
568 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
569 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR500;
571 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
572 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR450;
574 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
575 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
576 return MASK_DEFAULT_FR400;
578 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
579 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
580 return MASK_DEFAULT_SIMPLE;
582 default:
583 gcc_unreachable ();
587 /* Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make
588 sense on a particular target machine. You can define a macro
589 `OVERRIDE_OPTIONS' to take account of this. This macro, if
590 defined, is executed once just after all the command options have
591 been parsed.
593 Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
594 `-O'. That is what `OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS' is for. */
596 void
597 frv_override_options (void)
599 int regno;
600 unsigned int i;
602 target_flags |= (frv_default_flags_for_cpu () & ~target_flags_explicit);
604 /* -mlibrary-pic sets -fPIC and -G0 and also suppresses warnings from the
605 linker about linking pic and non-pic code. */
606 if (TARGET_LIBPIC)
608 if (!flag_pic) /* -fPIC */
609 flag_pic = 2;
611 if (! g_switch_set) /* -G0 */
613 g_switch_set = 1;
614 g_switch_value = 0;
618 /* A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard
619 register REGNO. In general there is more than one such class;
620 choose a class which is "minimal", meaning that no smaller class
621 also contains the register. */
623 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; regno++)
625 enum reg_class class;
627 if (GPR_P (regno))
629 int gpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
631 if (gpr_reg == GR8_REG)
632 class = GR8_REGS;
634 else if (gpr_reg == GR9_REG)
635 class = GR9_REGS;
637 else if (gpr_reg == GR14_REG)
638 class = FDPIC_FPTR_REGS;
640 else if (gpr_reg == FDPIC_REGNO)
641 class = FDPIC_REGS;
643 else if ((gpr_reg & 3) == 0)
644 class = QUAD_REGS;
646 else if ((gpr_reg & 1) == 0)
647 class = EVEN_REGS;
649 else
650 class = GPR_REGS;
653 else if (FPR_P (regno))
655 int fpr_reg = regno - GPR_FIRST;
656 if ((fpr_reg & 3) == 0)
657 class = QUAD_FPR_REGS;
659 else if ((fpr_reg & 1) == 0)
660 class = FEVEN_REGS;
662 else
663 class = FPR_REGS;
666 else if (regno == LR_REGNO)
667 class = LR_REG;
669 else if (regno == LCR_REGNO)
670 class = LCR_REG;
672 else if (ICC_P (regno))
673 class = ICC_REGS;
675 else if (FCC_P (regno))
676 class = FCC_REGS;
678 else if (ICR_P (regno))
679 class = ICR_REGS;
681 else if (FCR_P (regno))
682 class = FCR_REGS;
684 else if (ACC_P (regno))
686 int r = regno - ACC_FIRST;
687 if ((r & 3) == 0)
688 class = QUAD_ACC_REGS;
689 else if ((r & 1) == 0)
690 class = EVEN_ACC_REGS;
691 else
692 class = ACC_REGS;
695 else if (ACCG_P (regno))
696 class = ACCG_REGS;
698 else
699 class = NO_REGS;
701 regno_reg_class[regno] = class;
704 /* Check for small data option */
705 if (!g_switch_set)
706 g_switch_value = SDATA_DEFAULT_SIZE;
708 /* A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand
709 constraint letters for register classes. If CHAR is such a
710 letter, the value should be the register class corresponding to
711 it. Otherwise, the value should be `NO_REGS'. The register
712 letter `r', corresponding to class `GENERAL_REGS', will not be
713 passed to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
715 The following letters are unavailable, due to being used as
716 constraints:
717 '0'..'9'
718 '<', '>'
719 'E', 'F', 'G', 'H'
720 'I', 'J', 'K', 'L', 'M', 'N', 'O', 'P'
721 'Q', 'R', 'S', 'T', 'U'
722 'V', 'X'
723 'g', 'i', 'm', 'n', 'o', 'p', 'r', 's' */
725 for (i = 0; i < 256; i++)
726 reg_class_from_letter[i] = NO_REGS;
728 reg_class_from_letter['a'] = ACC_REGS;
729 reg_class_from_letter['b'] = EVEN_ACC_REGS;
730 reg_class_from_letter['c'] = CC_REGS;
731 reg_class_from_letter['d'] = GPR_REGS;
732 reg_class_from_letter['e'] = EVEN_REGS;
733 reg_class_from_letter['f'] = FPR_REGS;
734 reg_class_from_letter['h'] = FEVEN_REGS;
735 reg_class_from_letter['l'] = LR_REG;
736 reg_class_from_letter['q'] = QUAD_REGS;
737 reg_class_from_letter['t'] = ICC_REGS;
738 reg_class_from_letter['u'] = FCC_REGS;
739 reg_class_from_letter['v'] = ICR_REGS;
740 reg_class_from_letter['w'] = FCR_REGS;
741 reg_class_from_letter['x'] = QUAD_FPR_REGS;
742 reg_class_from_letter['y'] = LCR_REG;
743 reg_class_from_letter['z'] = SPR_REGS;
744 reg_class_from_letter['A'] = QUAD_ACC_REGS;
745 reg_class_from_letter['B'] = ACCG_REGS;
746 reg_class_from_letter['C'] = CR_REGS;
747 reg_class_from_letter['W'] = FDPIC_CALL_REGS; /* gp14+15 */
748 reg_class_from_letter['Z'] = FDPIC_REGS; /* gp15 */
750 /* There is no single unaligned SI op for PIC code. Sometimes we
751 need to use ".4byte" and sometimes we need to use ".picptr".
752 See frv_assemble_integer for details. */
753 if (flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC)
754 targetm.asm_out.unaligned_op.si = 0;
756 if ((target_flags_explicit & MASK_LINKED_FP) == 0)
757 target_flags |= MASK_LINKED_FP;
759 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_names); i++)
760 frv_unit_codes[i] = get_cpu_unit_code (frv_unit_names[i]);
762 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_type_to_unit); i++)
763 frv_type_to_unit[i] = ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes);
765 init_machine_status = frv_init_machine_status;
769 /* Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
770 various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once just
771 after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder of the
772 command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are used as the
773 default values for the other command line options.
775 LEVEL is the optimization level specified; 2 if `-O2' is specified, 1 if
776 `-O' is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
778 SIZE is nonzero if `-Os' is specified, 0 otherwise.
780 You should not use this macro to change options that are not
781 machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same optimization
782 level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable machine-specific
783 optimizations.
785 *Do not examine `write_symbols' in this macro!* The debugging options are
786 *not supposed to alter the generated code. */
788 /* On the FRV, possibly disable VLIW packing which is done by the 2nd
789 scheduling pass at the current time. */
790 void
791 frv_optimization_options (int level, int size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
793 if (level >= 2)
795 #ifdef DISABLE_SCHED2
796 flag_schedule_insns_after_reload = 0;
797 #endif
798 #ifdef ENABLE_RCSP
799 flag_rcsp = 1;
800 #endif
805 /* Return true if NAME (a STRING_CST node) begins with PREFIX. */
807 static int
808 frv_string_begins_with (tree name, const char *prefix)
810 int prefix_len = strlen (prefix);
812 /* Remember: NAME's length includes the null terminator. */
813 return (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (name) > prefix_len
814 && strncmp (TREE_STRING_POINTER (name), prefix, prefix_len) == 0);
817 /* Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify two variables
818 `fixed_regs' and `call_used_regs' (both of type `char []') after they have
819 been initialized from the two preceding macros.
821 This is necessary in case the fixed or call-clobbered registers depend on
822 target flags.
824 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
826 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target flags,
827 you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify `fixed_regs' and
828 `call_used_regs' to 1 for each of the registers in the classes which should
829 not be used by GCC. Also define the macro `REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER' to return
830 `NO_REGS' if it is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
832 (However, if this class is not included in `GENERAL_REGS' and all of the
833 insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are controlled by target
834 switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using these registers when the
835 target switches are opposed to them.) */
837 void
838 frv_conditional_register_usage (void)
840 int i;
842 for (i = GPR_FIRST + NUM_GPRS; i <= GPR_LAST; i++)
843 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
845 for (i = FPR_FIRST + NUM_FPRS; i <= FPR_LAST; i++)
846 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
848 /* Reserve the registers used for conditional execution. At present, we need
849 1 ICC and 1 ICR register. */
850 fixed_regs[ICC_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICC_TEMP] = 1;
851 fixed_regs[ICR_TEMP] = call_used_regs[ICR_TEMP] = 1;
853 if (TARGET_FIXED_CC)
855 fixed_regs[ICC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICC_FIRST] = 1;
856 fixed_regs[FCC_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCC_FIRST] = 1;
857 fixed_regs[ICR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[ICR_FIRST] = 1;
858 fixed_regs[FCR_FIRST] = call_used_regs[FCR_FIRST] = 1;
861 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
862 fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = fixed_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] =
863 call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 16] = call_used_regs[GPR_FIRST + 17] = 0;
865 #if 0
866 /* If -fpic, SDA_BASE_REG is the PIC register. */
867 if (g_switch_value == 0 && !flag_pic)
868 fixed_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = call_used_regs[SDA_BASE_REG] = 0;
870 if (!flag_pic)
871 fixed_regs[PIC_REGNO] = call_used_regs[PIC_REGNO] = 0;
872 #endif
877 * Compute the stack frame layout
879 * Register setup:
880 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
881 * |Register |type |caller-save/callee-save|
882 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
883 * |GR0 |Zero register | - |
884 * |GR1 |Stack pointer(SP) | - |
885 * |GR2 |Frame pointer(FP) | - |
886 * |GR3 |Hidden parameter | caller save |
887 * |GR4-GR7 | - | caller save |
888 * |GR8-GR13 |Argument register | caller save |
889 * |GR14-GR15 | - | caller save |
890 * |GR16-GR31 | - | callee save |
891 * |GR32-GR47 | - | caller save |
892 * |GR48-GR63 | - | callee save |
893 * |FR0-FR15 | - | caller save |
894 * |FR16-FR31 | - | callee save |
895 * |FR32-FR47 | - | caller save |
896 * |FR48-FR63 | - | callee save |
897 * +---------------+-----------------------+-----------------------+
899 * Stack frame setup:
900 * Low
901 * SP-> |-----------------------------------|
902 * | Argument area |
903 * |-----------------------------------|
904 * | Register save area |
905 * |-----------------------------------|
906 * | Local variable save area |
907 * FP-> |-----------------------------------|
908 * | Old FP |
909 * |-----------------------------------|
910 * | Hidden parameter save area |
911 * |-----------------------------------|
912 * | Return address(LR) storage area |
913 * |-----------------------------------|
914 * | Padding for alignment |
915 * |-----------------------------------|
916 * | Register argument area |
917 * OLD SP-> |-----------------------------------|
918 * | Parameter area |
919 * |-----------------------------------|
920 * High
922 * Argument area/Parameter area:
924 * When a function is called, this area is used for argument transfer. When
925 * the argument is set up by the caller function, this area is referred to as
926 * the argument area. When the argument is referenced by the callee function,
927 * this area is referred to as the parameter area. The area is allocated when
928 * all arguments cannot be placed on the argument register at the time of
929 * argument transfer.
931 * Register save area:
933 * This is a register save area that must be guaranteed for the caller
934 * function. This area is not secured when the register save operation is not
935 * needed.
937 * Local variable save area:
939 * This is the area for local variables and temporary variables.
941 * Old FP:
943 * This area stores the FP value of the caller function.
945 * Hidden parameter save area:
947 * This area stores the start address of the return value storage
948 * area for a struct/union return function.
949 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller
950 * function stores the return value storage area start address in
951 * register GR3 and passes it to the caller function.
952 * The callee function interprets the address stored in the GR3
953 * as the return value storage area start address.
954 * When register GR3 needs to be saved into memory, the callee
955 * function saves it in the hidden parameter save area. This
956 * area is not secured when the save operation is not needed.
958 * Return address(LR) storage area:
960 * This area saves the LR. The LR stores the address of a return to the caller
961 * function for the purpose of function calling.
963 * Argument register area:
965 * This area saves the argument register. This area is not secured when the
966 * save operation is not needed.
968 * Argument:
970 * Arguments, the count of which equals the count of argument registers (6
971 * words), are positioned in registers GR8 to GR13 and delivered to the callee
972 * function. When a struct/union return function is called, the return value
973 * area address is stored in register GR3. Arguments not placed in the
974 * argument registers will be stored in the stack argument area for transfer
975 * purposes. When an 8-byte type argument is to be delivered using registers,
976 * it is divided into two and placed in two registers for transfer. When
977 * argument registers must be saved to memory, the callee function secures an
978 * argument register save area in the stack. In this case, a continuous
979 * argument register save area must be established in the parameter area. The
980 * argument register save area must be allocated as needed to cover the size of
981 * the argument register to be saved. If the function has a variable count of
982 * arguments, it saves all argument registers in the argument register save
983 * area.
985 * Argument Extension Format:
987 * When an argument is to be stored in the stack, its type is converted to an
988 * extended type in accordance with the individual argument type. The argument
989 * is freed by the caller function after the return from the callee function is
990 * made.
992 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
993 * | Argument Type |Extended Type |Stack Storage Size(byte)|
994 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
995 * |char |int | 4 |
996 * |signed char |int | 4 |
997 * |unsigned char |int | 4 |
998 * |[signed] short int |int | 4 |
999 * |unsigned short int |int | 4 |
1000 * |[signed] int |No extension | 4 |
1001 * |unsigned int |No extension | 4 |
1002 * |[signed] long int |No extension | 4 |
1003 * |unsigned long int |No extension | 4 |
1004 * |[signed] long long int |No extension | 8 |
1005 * |unsigned long long int |No extension | 8 |
1006 * |float |double | 8 |
1007 * |double |No extension | 8 |
1008 * |long double |No extension | 8 |
1009 * |pointer |No extension | 4 |
1010 * |struct/union |- | 4 (*1) |
1011 * +-----------------------+---------------+------------------------+
1013 * When a struct/union is to be delivered as an argument, the caller copies it
1014 * to the local variable area and delivers the address of that area.
1016 * Return Value:
1018 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
1019 * |Return Value Type |Return Value Interface|
1020 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
1021 * |void |None |
1022 * |[signed|unsigned] char |GR8 |
1023 * |[signed|unsigned] short int |GR8 |
1024 * |[signed|unsigned] int |GR8 |
1025 * |[signed|unsigned] long int |GR8 |
1026 * |pointer |GR8 |
1027 * |[signed|unsigned] long long int|GR8 & GR9 |
1028 * |float |GR8 |
1029 * |double |GR8 & GR9 |
1030 * |long double |GR8 & GR9 |
1031 * |struct/union |(*1) |
1032 * +-------------------------------+----------------------+
1034 * When a struct/union is used as the return value, the caller function stores
1035 * the start address of the return value storage area into GR3 and then passes
1036 * it to the callee function. The callee function interprets GR3 as the start
1037 * address of the return value storage area. When this address needs to be
1038 * saved in memory, the callee function secures the hidden parameter save area
1039 * and saves the address in that area.
1042 frv_stack_t *
1043 frv_stack_info (void)
1045 static frv_stack_t info, zero_info;
1046 frv_stack_t *info_ptr = &info;
1047 tree fndecl = current_function_decl;
1048 int varargs_p = 0;
1049 tree cur_arg;
1050 tree next_arg;
1051 int range;
1052 int alignment;
1053 int offset;
1055 /* If we've already calculated the values and reload is complete,
1056 just return now. */
1057 if (frv_stack_cache)
1058 return frv_stack_cache;
1060 /* Zero all fields. */
1061 info = zero_info;
1063 /* Set up the register range information. */
1064 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].name = "gpr";
1065 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].first = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1;
1066 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].last = GPR_LAST;
1067 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_GPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1069 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].name = "fpr";
1070 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].first = FPR_FIRST;
1071 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].last = FPR_LAST;
1072 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FPR].dword_p = TRUE;
1074 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].name = "lr";
1075 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].first = LR_REGNO;
1076 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].last = LR_REGNO;
1077 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].special_p = 1;
1079 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].name = "cc";
1080 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].first = CC_FIRST;
1081 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].last = CC_LAST;
1082 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_CC].field_p = TRUE;
1084 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].name = "lcr";
1085 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].first = LCR_REGNO;
1086 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LCR].last = LCR_REGNO;
1088 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].name = "stdarg";
1089 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
1090 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last = LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
1091 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].dword_p = 1;
1092 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].special_p = 1;
1094 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].name = "struct";
1095 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].first = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1096 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].last = FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM;
1097 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].special_p = 1;
1099 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].name = "fp";
1100 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].first = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1101 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].last = FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1102 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].special_p = 1;
1104 /* Determine if this is a stdarg function. If so, allocate space to store
1105 the 6 arguments. */
1106 if (cfun->stdarg)
1107 varargs_p = 1;
1109 else
1111 /* Find the last argument, and see if it is __builtin_va_alist. */
1112 for (cur_arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl); cur_arg != (tree)0; cur_arg = next_arg)
1114 next_arg = TREE_CHAIN (cur_arg);
1115 if (next_arg == (tree)0)
1117 if (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)
1118 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (cur_arg)), "__builtin_va_alist"))
1119 varargs_p = 1;
1121 break;
1126 /* Iterate over all of the register ranges. */
1127 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1129 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1130 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1131 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1132 int size_1word = 0;
1133 int size_2words = 0;
1134 int regno;
1136 /* Calculate which registers need to be saved & save area size. */
1137 switch (range)
1139 default:
1140 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1142 if ((regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
1143 || (current_function_calls_eh_return
1144 && (regno >= FIRST_EH_REGNUM && regno <= LAST_EH_REGNUM))
1145 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1146 && cfun->uses_pic_offset_table && regno == PIC_REGNO))
1148 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1149 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1152 break;
1154 /* Calculate whether we need to create a frame after everything else
1155 has been processed. */
1156 case STACK_REGS_FP:
1157 break;
1159 case STACK_REGS_LR:
1160 if (regs_ever_live[LR_REGNO]
1161 || profile_flag
1162 /* This is set for __builtin_return_address, etc. */
1163 || cfun->machine->frame_needed
1164 || (TARGET_LINKED_FP && frame_pointer_needed)
1165 || (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic
1166 && cfun->uses_pic_offset_table))
1168 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1169 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1171 break;
1173 case STACK_REGS_STDARG:
1174 if (varargs_p)
1176 /* If this is a stdarg function with a non varardic
1177 argument split between registers and the stack,
1178 adjust the saved registers downward. */
1179 last -= (ADDR_ALIGN (cfun->pretend_args_size, UNITS_PER_WORD)
1180 / UNITS_PER_WORD);
1182 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1184 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1185 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1188 info_ptr->stdarg_size = size_1word;
1190 break;
1192 case STACK_REGS_STRUCT:
1193 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1195 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1196 size_1word += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1198 break;
1202 if (size_1word)
1204 /* If this is a field, it only takes one word. */
1205 if (reg_ptr->field_p)
1206 size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1208 /* Determine which register pairs can be saved together. */
1209 else if (reg_ptr->dword_p && TARGET_DWORD)
1211 for (regno = first; regno < last; regno += 2)
1213 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] && info_ptr->save_p[regno+1])
1215 size_2words += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1216 size_1word -= 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1217 info_ptr->save_p[regno] = REG_SAVE_2WORDS;
1218 info_ptr->save_p[regno+1] = REG_SAVE_NO_SAVE;
1223 reg_ptr->size_1word = size_1word;
1224 reg_ptr->size_2words = size_2words;
1226 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1228 info_ptr->regs_size_1word += size_1word;
1229 info_ptr->regs_size_2words += size_2words;
1234 /* Set up the sizes of each each field in the frame body, making the sizes
1235 of each be divisible by the size of a dword if dword operations might
1236 be used, or the size of a word otherwise. */
1237 alignment = (TARGET_DWORD? 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD : UNITS_PER_WORD);
1239 info_ptr->parameter_size = ADDR_ALIGN (cfun->outgoing_args_size, alignment);
1240 info_ptr->regs_size = ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->regs_size_2words
1241 + info_ptr->regs_size_1word,
1242 alignment);
1243 info_ptr->vars_size = ADDR_ALIGN (get_frame_size (), alignment);
1245 info_ptr->pretend_size = cfun->pretend_args_size;
1247 /* Work out the size of the frame, excluding the header. Both the frame
1248 body and register parameter area will be dword-aligned. */
1249 info_ptr->total_size
1250 = (ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->parameter_size
1251 + info_ptr->regs_size
1252 + info_ptr->vars_size,
1253 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD)
1254 + ADDR_ALIGN (info_ptr->pretend_size
1255 + info_ptr->stdarg_size,
1256 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD));
1258 /* See if we need to create a frame at all, if so add header area. */
1259 if (info_ptr->total_size > 0
1260 || frame_pointer_needed
1261 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word > 0
1262 || info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word > 0)
1264 offset = info_ptr->parameter_size;
1265 info_ptr->header_size = 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1266 info_ptr->total_size += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1268 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal register pairs. */
1269 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1271 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1272 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1274 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1275 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1276 int regno;
1278 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1279 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1280 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1281 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1282 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1284 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1285 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1290 /* Calculate the offsets to save normal single registers. */
1291 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1293 frv_stack_regs_t *reg_ptr = &(info_ptr->regs[range]);
1294 if (! reg_ptr->special_p)
1296 int first = reg_ptr->first;
1297 int last = reg_ptr->last;
1298 int regno;
1300 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1301 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD
1302 && regno != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1303 && (regno < FIRST_ARG_REGNUM
1304 || regno > LAST_ARG_REGNUM))
1306 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1307 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1312 /* Calculate the offset to save the local variables at. */
1313 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, alignment);
1314 if (info_ptr->vars_size)
1316 info_ptr->vars_offset = offset;
1317 offset += info_ptr->vars_size;
1320 /* Align header to a dword-boundary. */
1321 offset = ADDR_ALIGN (offset, 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD);
1323 /* Calculate the offsets in the fixed frame. */
1324 info_ptr->save_p[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1325 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM] = offset;
1326 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_FP].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1328 info_ptr->save_p[LR_REGNO] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1329 info_ptr->reg_offset[LR_REGNO] = offset + 2*UNITS_PER_WORD;
1330 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_LR].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1332 if (cfun->returns_struct)
1334 info_ptr->save_p[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = REG_SAVE_1WORD;
1335 info_ptr->reg_offset[FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM] = offset + UNITS_PER_WORD;
1336 info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STRUCT].size_1word = UNITS_PER_WORD;
1339 /* Calculate the offsets to store the arguments passed in registers
1340 for stdarg functions. The register pairs are first and the single
1341 register if any is last. The register save area starts on a
1342 dword-boundary. */
1343 if (info_ptr->stdarg_size)
1345 int first = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].first;
1346 int last = info_ptr->regs[STACK_REGS_STDARG].last;
1347 int regno;
1349 /* Skip the header. */
1350 offset += 4 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1351 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1353 if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1355 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1356 offset += 2 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
1358 else if (info_ptr->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1360 info_ptr->reg_offset[regno] = offset;
1361 offset += UNITS_PER_WORD;
1367 if (reload_completed)
1368 frv_stack_cache = info_ptr;
1370 return info_ptr;
1374 /* Print the information about the frv stack offsets, etc. when debugging. */
1376 void
1377 frv_debug_stack (frv_stack_t *info)
1379 int range;
1381 if (!info)
1382 info = frv_stack_info ();
1384 fprintf (stderr, "\nStack information for function %s:\n",
1385 ((current_function_decl && DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1386 ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl))
1387 : "<unknown>"));
1389 fprintf (stderr, "\ttotal_size\t= %6d\n", info->total_size);
1390 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_size\t= %6d\n", info->vars_size);
1391 fprintf (stderr, "\tparam_size\t= %6d\n", info->parameter_size);
1392 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_size\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d\n",
1393 info->regs_size, info->regs_size_1word, info->regs_size_2words);
1395 fprintf (stderr, "\theader_size\t= %6d\n", info->header_size);
1396 fprintf (stderr, "\tpretend_size\t= %6d\n", info->pretend_size);
1397 fprintf (stderr, "\tvars_offset\t= %6d\n", info->vars_offset);
1398 fprintf (stderr, "\tregs_offset\t= %6d\n", info->regs_offset);
1400 for (range = 0; range < STACK_REGS_MAX; range++)
1402 frv_stack_regs_t *regs = &(info->regs[range]);
1403 if ((regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words) > 0)
1405 int first = regs->first;
1406 int last = regs->last;
1407 int regno;
1409 fprintf (stderr, "\t%s\tsize\t= %6d, 1w = %3d, 2w = %3d, save =",
1410 regs->name, regs->size_1word + regs->size_2words,
1411 regs->size_1word, regs->size_2words);
1413 for (regno = first; regno <= last; regno++)
1415 if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_1WORD)
1416 fprintf (stderr, " %s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1417 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1419 else if (info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS)
1420 fprintf (stderr, " %s-%s (%d)", reg_names[regno],
1421 reg_names[regno+1], info->reg_offset[regno]);
1424 fputc ('\n', stderr);
1428 fflush (stderr);
1434 /* Used during final to control the packing of insns. The value is
1435 1 if the current instruction should be packed with the next one,
1436 0 if it shouldn't or -1 if packing is disabled altogether. */
1438 static int frv_insn_packing_flag;
1440 /* True if the current function contains a far jump. */
1442 static int
1443 frv_function_contains_far_jump (void)
1445 rtx insn = get_insns ();
1446 while (insn != NULL
1447 && !(GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
1448 /* Ignore tablejump patterns. */
1449 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
1450 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC
1451 && get_attr_far_jump (insn) == FAR_JUMP_YES))
1452 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
1453 return (insn != NULL);
1456 /* For the FRV, this function makes sure that a function with far jumps
1457 will return correctly. It also does the VLIW packing. */
1459 static void
1460 frv_function_prologue (FILE *file, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1462 /* If no frame was created, check whether the function uses a call
1463 instruction to implement a far jump. If so, save the link in gr3 and
1464 replace all returns to LR with returns to GR3. GR3 is used because it
1465 is call-clobbered, because is not available to the register allocator,
1466 and because all functions that take a hidden argument pointer will have
1467 a stack frame. */
1468 if (frv_stack_info ()->total_size == 0 && frv_function_contains_far_jump ())
1470 rtx insn;
1472 /* Just to check that the above comment is true. */
1473 gcc_assert (!regs_ever_live[GPR_FIRST + 3]);
1475 /* Generate the instruction that saves the link register. */
1476 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg lr,gr3\n");
1478 /* Replace the LR with GR3 in *return_internal patterns. The insn
1479 will now return using jmpl @(gr3,0) rather than bralr. We cannot
1480 simply emit a different assembly directive because bralr and jmpl
1481 execute in different units. */
1482 for (insn = get_insns(); insn != NULL; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1483 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
1485 rtx pattern = PATTERN (insn);
1486 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
1487 && XVECLEN (pattern, 0) >= 2
1488 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 0)) == RETURN
1489 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1)) == USE)
1491 rtx address = XEXP (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, 1), 0);
1492 if (GET_CODE (address) == REG && REGNO (address) == LR_REGNO)
1493 REGNO (address) = GPR_FIRST + 3;
1498 frv_pack_insns ();
1500 /* Allow the garbage collector to free the nops created by frv_reorg. */
1501 memset (frv_nops, 0, sizeof (frv_nops));
1505 /* Return the next available temporary register in a given class. */
1507 static rtx
1508 frv_alloc_temp_reg (
1509 frv_tmp_reg_t *info, /* which registers are available */
1510 enum reg_class class, /* register class desired */
1511 enum machine_mode mode, /* mode to allocate register with */
1512 int mark_as_used, /* register not available after allocation */
1513 int no_abort) /* return NULL instead of aborting */
1515 int regno = info->next_reg[ (int)class ];
1516 int orig_regno = regno;
1517 HARD_REG_SET *reg_in_class = &reg_class_contents[ (int)class ];
1518 int i, nr;
1520 for (;;)
1522 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (*reg_in_class, regno)
1523 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno))
1524 break;
1526 if (++regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1527 regno = 0;
1528 if (regno == orig_regno)
1530 gcc_assert (no_abort);
1531 return NULL_RTX;
1535 nr = HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode);
1536 info->next_reg[ (int)class ] = regno + nr;
1538 if (mark_as_used)
1539 for (i = 0; i < nr; i++)
1540 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (info->regs, regno+i);
1542 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
1546 /* Return an rtx with the value OFFSET, which will either be a register or a
1547 signed 12-bit integer. It can be used as the second operand in an "add"
1548 instruction, or as the index in a load or store.
1550 The function returns a constant rtx if OFFSET is small enough, otherwise
1551 it loads the constant into register OFFSET_REGNO and returns that. */
1552 static rtx
1553 frv_frame_offset_rtx (int offset)
1555 rtx offset_rtx = GEN_INT (offset);
1556 if (IN_RANGE_P (offset, -2048, 2047))
1557 return offset_rtx;
1558 else
1560 rtx reg_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO);
1561 if (IN_RANGE_P (offset, -32768, 32767))
1562 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1563 else
1565 emit_insn (gen_movsi_high (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1566 emit_insn (gen_movsi_lo_sum (reg_rtx, offset_rtx));
1568 return reg_rtx;
1572 /* Generate (mem:MODE (plus:Pmode BASE (frv_frame_offset OFFSET)))). The
1573 prologue and epilogue uses such expressions to access the stack. */
1574 static rtx
1575 frv_frame_mem (enum machine_mode mode, rtx base, int offset)
1577 return gen_rtx_MEM (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
1578 base,
1579 frv_frame_offset_rtx (offset)));
1582 /* Generate a frame-related expression:
1584 (set REG (mem (plus (sp) (const_int OFFSET)))).
1586 Such expressions are used in FRAME_RELATED_EXPR notes for more complex
1587 instructions. Marking the expressions as frame-related is superfluous if
1588 the note contains just a single set. But if the note contains a PARALLEL
1589 or SEQUENCE that has several sets, each set must be individually marked
1590 as frame-related. */
1591 static rtx
1592 frv_dwarf_store (rtx reg, int offset)
1594 rtx set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
1595 gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (reg),
1596 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
1597 offset)),
1598 reg);
1599 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (set) = 1;
1600 return set;
1603 /* Emit a frame-related instruction whose pattern is PATTERN. The
1604 instruction is the last in a sequence that cumulatively performs the
1605 operation described by DWARF_PATTERN. The instruction is marked as
1606 frame-related and has a REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR note containing
1607 DWARF_PATTERN. */
1608 static void
1609 frv_frame_insn (rtx pattern, rtx dwarf_pattern)
1611 rtx insn = emit_insn (pattern);
1612 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
1613 REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
1614 dwarf_pattern,
1615 REG_NOTES (insn));
1618 /* Emit instructions that transfer REG to or from the memory location (sp +
1619 STACK_OFFSET). The register is stored in memory if ACCESSOR->OP is
1620 FRV_STORE and loaded if it is FRV_LOAD. Only the prologue uses this
1621 function to store registers and only the epilogue uses it to load them.
1623 The caller sets up ACCESSOR so that BASE is equal to (sp + BASE_OFFSET).
1624 The generated instruction will use BASE as its base register. BASE may
1625 simply be the stack pointer, but if several accesses are being made to a
1626 region far away from the stack pointer, it may be more efficient to set
1627 up a temporary instead.
1629 Store instructions will be frame-related and will be annotated with the
1630 overall effect of the store. Load instructions will be followed by a
1631 (use) to prevent later optimizations from zapping them.
1633 The function takes care of the moves to and from SPRs, using TEMP_REGNO
1634 as a temporary in such cases. */
1635 static void
1636 frv_frame_access (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor, rtx reg, int stack_offset)
1638 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
1639 rtx mem = frv_frame_mem (mode,
1640 accessor->base,
1641 stack_offset - accessor->base_offset);
1643 if (accessor->op == FRV_LOAD)
1645 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1647 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1648 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, mem));
1649 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, temp));
1651 else
1652 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, mem));
1653 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg));
1655 else
1657 if (SPR_P (REGNO (reg)))
1659 rtx temp = gen_rtx_REG (mode, TEMP_REGNO);
1660 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, temp, reg));
1661 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, temp),
1662 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1664 else if (GET_MODE (reg) == DImode)
1666 /* For DImode saves, the dwarf2 version needs to be a SEQUENCE
1667 with a separate save for each register. */
1668 rtx reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg));
1669 rtx reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (reg) + 1);
1670 rtx set1 = frv_dwarf_store (reg1, stack_offset);
1671 rtx set2 = frv_dwarf_store (reg2, stack_offset + 4);
1672 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1673 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
1674 gen_rtvec (2, set1, set2)));
1676 else
1677 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (Pmode, mem, reg),
1678 frv_dwarf_store (reg, stack_offset));
1682 /* A function that uses frv_frame_access to transfer a group of registers to
1683 or from the stack. ACCESSOR is passed directly to frv_frame_access, INFO
1684 is the stack information generated by frv_stack_info, and REG_SET is the
1685 number of the register set to transfer. */
1686 static void
1687 frv_frame_access_multi (frv_frame_accessor_t *accessor,
1688 frv_stack_t *info,
1689 int reg_set)
1691 frv_stack_regs_t *regs_info;
1692 int regno;
1694 regs_info = &info->regs[reg_set];
1695 for (regno = regs_info->first; regno <= regs_info->last; regno++)
1696 if (info->save_p[regno])
1697 frv_frame_access (accessor,
1698 info->save_p[regno] == REG_SAVE_2WORDS
1699 ? gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno)
1700 : gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno),
1701 info->reg_offset[regno]);
1704 /* Save or restore callee-saved registers that are kept outside the frame
1705 header. The function saves the registers if OP is FRV_STORE and restores
1706 them if OP is FRV_LOAD. INFO is the stack information generated by
1707 frv_stack_info. */
1708 static void
1709 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (enum frv_stack_op op, frv_stack_t *info)
1711 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1713 accessor.op = op;
1714 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1715 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1716 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_GPR);
1717 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_FPR);
1718 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LCR);
1722 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1723 prologue. Using a prologue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1724 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1725 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1726 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1727 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1728 scheduling.
1730 Also any insns generated here should have RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P(insn) = 1
1731 so that the debug info generation code can handle them properly. */
1732 void
1733 frv_expand_prologue (void)
1735 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1736 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1737 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1738 frv_frame_accessor_t accessor;
1740 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
1741 frv_debug_stack (info);
1743 if (info->total_size == 0)
1744 return;
1746 /* We're interested in three areas of the frame here:
1748 A: the register save area
1749 B: the old FP
1750 C: the header after B
1752 If the frame pointer isn't used, we'll have to set up A, B and C
1753 using the stack pointer. If the frame pointer is used, we'll access
1754 them as follows:
1756 A: set up using sp
1757 B: set up using sp or a temporary (see below)
1758 C: set up using fp
1760 We set up B using the stack pointer if the frame is small enough.
1761 Otherwise, it's more efficient to copy the old stack pointer into a
1762 temporary and use that.
1764 Note that it's important to make sure the prologue and epilogue use the
1765 same registers to access A and C, since doing otherwise will confuse
1766 the aliasing code. */
1768 /* Set up ACCESSOR for accessing region B above. If the frame pointer
1769 isn't used, the same method will serve for C. */
1770 accessor.op = FRV_STORE;
1771 if (frame_pointer_needed && info->total_size > 2048)
1773 rtx insn;
1775 accessor.base = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, OLD_SP_REGNO);
1776 accessor.base_offset = info->total_size;
1777 insn = emit_insn (gen_movsi (accessor.base, sp));
1779 else
1781 accessor.base = stack_pointer_rtx;
1782 accessor.base_offset = 0;
1785 /* Allocate the stack space. */
1787 rtx asm_offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (-info->total_size);
1788 rtx dwarf_offset = GEN_INT (-info->total_size);
1790 frv_frame_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, asm_offset),
1791 gen_rtx_SET (Pmode,
1793 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, sp, dwarf_offset)));
1796 /* If the frame pointer is needed, store the old one at (sp + FP_OFFSET)
1797 and point the new one to that location. */
1798 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1800 int fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1802 /* ASM_SRC and DWARF_SRC both point to the frame header. ASM_SRC is
1803 based on ACCESSOR.BASE but DWARF_SRC is always based on the stack
1804 pointer. */
1805 rtx asm_src = plus_constant (accessor.base,
1806 fp_offset - accessor.base_offset);
1807 rtx dwarf_src = plus_constant (sp, fp_offset);
1809 /* Store the old frame pointer at (sp + FP_OFFSET). */
1810 frv_frame_access (&accessor, fp, fp_offset);
1812 /* Set up the new frame pointer. */
1813 frv_frame_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, asm_src),
1814 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, dwarf_src));
1816 /* Access region C from the frame pointer. */
1817 accessor.base = fp;
1818 accessor.base_offset = fp_offset;
1821 /* Set up region C. */
1822 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STRUCT);
1823 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_LR);
1824 frv_frame_access_multi (&accessor, info, STACK_REGS_STDARG);
1826 /* Set up region A. */
1827 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_STORE, info);
1829 /* If this is a varargs/stdarg function, issue a blockage to prevent the
1830 scheduler from moving loads before the stores saving the registers. */
1831 if (info->stdarg_size > 0)
1832 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
1834 /* Set up pic register/small data register for this function. */
1835 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && cfun->uses_pic_offset_table)
1836 emit_insn (gen_pic_prologue (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, PIC_REGNO),
1837 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO),
1838 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, OFFSET_REGNO)));
1842 /* Under frv, all of the work is done via frv_expand_epilogue, but
1843 this function provides a convenient place to do cleanup. */
1845 static void
1846 frv_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1847 HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1849 frv_stack_cache = (frv_stack_t *)0;
1851 /* Zap last used registers for conditional execution. */
1852 memset (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, 0, sizeof (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg));
1854 /* Release the bitmap of created insns. */
1855 BITMAP_FREE (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap);
1859 /* Called after register allocation to add any instructions needed for the
1860 epilogue. Using an epilogue insn is favored compared to putting all of the
1861 instructions in the TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE target hook, since
1862 it allows the scheduler to intermix instructions with the saves of
1863 the caller saved registers. In some cases, it might be necessary
1864 to emit a barrier instruction as the last insn to prevent such
1865 scheduling. */
1867 void
1868 frv_expand_epilogue (bool emit_return)
1870 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
1871 rtx fp = frame_pointer_rtx;
1872 rtx sp = stack_pointer_rtx;
1873 rtx return_addr;
1874 int fp_offset;
1876 fp_offset = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
1878 /* Restore the stack pointer to its original value if alloca or the like
1879 is used. */
1880 if (! current_function_sp_is_unchanging)
1881 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (sp, fp, frv_frame_offset_rtx (-fp_offset)));
1883 /* Restore the callee-saved registers that were used in this function. */
1884 frv_frame_access_standard_regs (FRV_LOAD, info);
1886 /* Set RETURN_ADDR to the address we should return to. Set it to NULL if
1887 no return instruction should be emitted. */
1888 if (info->save_p[LR_REGNO])
1890 int lr_offset;
1891 rtx mem;
1893 /* Use the same method to access the link register's slot as we did in
1894 the prologue. In other words, use the frame pointer if available,
1895 otherwise use the stack pointer.
1897 LR_OFFSET is the offset of the link register's slot from the start
1898 of the frame and MEM is a memory rtx for it. */
1899 lr_offset = info->reg_offset[LR_REGNO];
1900 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1901 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, fp, lr_offset - fp_offset);
1902 else
1903 mem = frv_frame_mem (Pmode, sp, lr_offset);
1905 /* Load the old link register into a GPR. */
1906 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, TEMP_REGNO);
1907 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, return_addr, mem));
1909 else
1910 return_addr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1912 /* Restore the old frame pointer. Emit a USE afterwards to make sure
1913 the load is preserved. */
1914 if (frame_pointer_needed)
1916 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, fp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, fp)));
1917 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, fp));
1920 /* Deallocate the stack frame. */
1921 if (info->total_size != 0)
1923 rtx offset = frv_frame_offset_rtx (info->total_size);
1924 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, offset));
1927 /* If this function uses eh_return, add the final stack adjustment now. */
1928 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
1929 emit_insn (gen_stack_adjust (sp, sp, EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX));
1931 if (emit_return)
1932 emit_jump_insn (gen_epilogue_return (return_addr));
1933 else
1935 rtx lr = return_addr;
1937 if (REGNO (return_addr) != LR_REGNO)
1939 lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
1940 emit_move_insn (lr, return_addr);
1943 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, lr));
1948 /* Worker function for TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK. */
1950 static void
1951 frv_asm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file,
1952 tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1953 HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
1954 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1955 tree function)
1957 const char *name_func = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 0);
1958 const char *name_arg0 = reg_names[FIRST_ARG_REGNUM];
1959 const char *name_jmp = reg_names[JUMP_REGNO];
1960 const char *parallel = (frv_issue_rate () > 1 ? ".p" : "");
1962 /* Do the add using an addi if possible. */
1963 if (IN_RANGE_P (delta, -2048, 2047))
1964 fprintf (file, "\taddi %s,#%d,%s\n", name_arg0, (int) delta, name_arg0);
1965 else
1967 const char *const name_add = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
1968 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1969 parallel, delta, name_add);
1970 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "),%s\n",
1971 delta, name_add);
1972 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_add, name_arg0, name_arg0);
1975 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
1977 const char *name_pic = reg_names[FDPIC_REGNO];
1978 name_jmp = reg_names[FDPIC_FPTR_REGNO];
1980 if (flag_pic != 1)
1982 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gotofffuncdeschi(", parallel);
1983 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1984 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
1986 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gotofffuncdesclo(");
1987 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1988 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
1990 fprintf (file, "\tldd @(%s,%s), %s\n", name_jmp, name_pic, name_jmp);
1992 else
1994 fprintf (file, "\tlddo @(%s,#gotofffuncdesc12(", name_pic);
1995 assemble_name (file, name_func);
1996 fprintf (file, "\t)), %s\n", name_jmp);
1999 else if (!flag_pic)
2001 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #hi(", parallel);
2002 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2003 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2005 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #lo(");
2006 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2007 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_jmp);
2009 else
2011 /* Use JUMP_REGNO as a temporary PIC register. */
2012 const char *name_lr = reg_names[LR_REGNO];
2013 const char *name_gppic = name_jmp;
2014 const char *name_tmp = reg_names[TEMP_REGNO];
2016 fprintf (file, "\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_tmp);
2017 fprintf (file, "\tcall 1f\n");
2018 fprintf (file, "1:\tmovsg %s,%s\n", name_lr, name_gppic);
2019 fprintf (file, "\tmovgs %s,%s\n", name_tmp, name_lr);
2020 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(1b),%s\n", parallel, name_tmp);
2021 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(1b),%s\n", name_tmp);
2022 fprintf (file, "\tsub %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_gppic);
2024 fprintf (file, "\tsethi%s #gprelhi(", parallel);
2025 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2026 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2028 fprintf (file, "\tsetlo #gprello(");
2029 assemble_name (file, name_func);
2030 fprintf (file, "),%s\n", name_tmp);
2032 fprintf (file, "\tadd %s,%s,%s\n", name_gppic, name_tmp, name_jmp);
2035 /* Jump to the function address. */
2036 fprintf (file, "\tjmpl @(%s,%s)\n", name_jmp, reg_names[GPR_FIRST+0]);
2040 /* A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
2041 pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
2042 nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
2044 The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
2045 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the constant
2046 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated with no
2047 frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1 when there is
2048 no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
2050 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
2051 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
2052 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
2053 `FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED' says. You don't need to worry about them.
2055 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
2056 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a fixed
2057 register. See `FIXED_REGISTERS' for more information. */
2059 /* On frv, create a frame whenever we need to create stack. */
2062 frv_frame_pointer_required (void)
2064 /* If we forgoing the usual linkage requirements, we only need
2065 a frame pointer if the stack pointer might change. */
2066 if (!TARGET_LINKED_FP)
2067 return !current_function_sp_is_unchanging;
2069 if (! current_function_is_leaf)
2070 return TRUE;
2072 if (get_frame_size () != 0)
2073 return TRUE;
2075 if (cfun->stdarg)
2076 return TRUE;
2078 if (!current_function_sp_is_unchanging)
2079 return TRUE;
2081 if (!TARGET_FDPIC && flag_pic && cfun->uses_pic_offset_table)
2082 return TRUE;
2084 if (profile_flag)
2085 return TRUE;
2087 if (cfun->machine->frame_needed)
2088 return TRUE;
2090 return FALSE;
2094 /* This macro is similar to `INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET'. It specifies the
2095 initial difference between the specified pair of registers. This macro must
2096 be defined if `ELIMINABLE_REGS' is defined. */
2098 /* See frv_stack_info for more details on the frv stack frame. */
2101 frv_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
2103 frv_stack_t *info = frv_stack_info ();
2104 int ret = 0;
2106 if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2107 ret = info->total_size - info->pretend_size;
2109 else if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2110 ret = info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM];
2112 else if (to == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
2113 ret = (info->total_size
2114 - info->reg_offset[FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM]
2115 - info->pretend_size);
2117 else
2118 gcc_unreachable ();
2120 if (TARGET_DEBUG_STACK)
2121 fprintf (stderr, "Eliminate %s to %s by adding %d\n",
2122 reg_names [from], reg_names[to], ret);
2124 return ret;
2128 /* Worker function for TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS. */
2130 static void
2131 frv_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
2132 enum machine_mode mode,
2133 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2134 int *pretend_size,
2135 int second_time)
2137 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2138 fprintf (stderr,
2139 "setup_vararg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, pretend_size = %d, second_time = %d\n",
2140 *cum, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), *pretend_size, second_time);
2144 /* Worker function for TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS. */
2146 static rtx
2147 frv_expand_builtin_saveregs (void)
2149 int offset = UNITS_PER_WORD * FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2151 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2152 fprintf (stderr, "expand_builtin_saveregs: offset from ap = %d\n",
2153 offset);
2155 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx, GEN_INT (- offset));
2159 /* Expand __builtin_va_start to do the va_start macro. */
2161 void
2162 frv_expand_builtin_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg)
2164 tree t;
2165 int num = cfun->args_info - FIRST_ARG_REGNUM - FRV_NUM_ARG_REGS;
2167 nextarg = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
2168 GEN_INT (UNITS_PER_WORD * num));
2170 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
2172 fprintf (stderr, "va_start: args_info = %d, num = %d\n",
2173 cfun->args_info, num);
2175 debug_rtx (nextarg);
2178 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
2179 make_tree (ptr_type_node, nextarg));
2180 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
2182 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2186 /* Expand a block move operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2187 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2189 operands[0] is the destination
2190 operands[1] is the source
2191 operands[2] is the length
2192 operands[3] is the alignment */
2194 /* Maximum number of loads to do before doing the stores */
2195 #ifndef MAX_MOVE_REG
2196 #define MAX_MOVE_REG 4
2197 #endif
2199 /* Maximum number of total loads to do. */
2200 #ifndef TOTAL_MOVE_REG
2201 #define TOTAL_MOVE_REG 8
2202 #endif
2205 frv_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
2207 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2208 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
2209 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
2210 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
2211 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2212 int align;
2213 int bytes;
2214 int offset;
2215 int num_reg;
2216 int i;
2217 rtx src_reg;
2218 rtx dest_reg;
2219 rtx src_addr;
2220 rtx dest_addr;
2221 rtx src_mem;
2222 rtx dest_mem;
2223 rtx tmp_reg;
2224 rtx stores[MAX_MOVE_REG];
2225 int move_bytes;
2226 enum machine_mode mode;
2228 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2229 if (! constp)
2230 return FALSE;
2232 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2233 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2235 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2237 /* Anything to move? */
2238 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2239 if (bytes <= 0)
2240 return TRUE;
2242 /* Don't support real large moves. */
2243 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2244 return FALSE;
2246 /* Move the address into scratch registers. */
2247 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2248 src_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0));
2250 num_reg = offset = 0;
2251 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= move_bytes), (offset += move_bytes))
2253 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2254 if (offset == 0)
2256 src_addr = src_reg;
2257 dest_addr = dest_reg;
2259 else
2261 src_addr = plus_constant (src_reg, offset);
2262 dest_addr = plus_constant (dest_reg, offset);
2265 /* Generate the appropriate load and store, saving the stores
2266 for later. */
2267 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2268 mode = SImode;
2269 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2270 mode = HImode;
2271 else
2272 mode = QImode;
2274 move_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2275 tmp_reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2276 src_mem = change_address (orig_src, mode, src_addr);
2277 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2278 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp_reg, src_mem));
2279 stores[num_reg++] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, tmp_reg);
2281 if (num_reg >= MAX_MOVE_REG)
2283 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2284 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2285 num_reg = 0;
2289 for (i = 0; i < num_reg; i++)
2290 emit_insn (stores[i]);
2292 return TRUE;
2296 /* Expand a block clear operation, and return 1 if successful. Return 0
2297 if we should let the compiler generate normal code.
2299 operands[0] is the destination
2300 operands[1] is the length
2301 operands[2] is the alignment */
2304 frv_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
2306 rtx orig_dest = operands[0];
2307 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
2308 rtx align_rtx = operands[2];
2309 int constp = (GET_CODE (bytes_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2310 int align;
2311 int bytes;
2312 int offset;
2313 int num_reg;
2314 rtx dest_reg;
2315 rtx dest_addr;
2316 rtx dest_mem;
2317 int clear_bytes;
2318 enum machine_mode mode;
2320 /* If this is not a fixed size move, just call memcpy. */
2321 if (! constp)
2322 return FALSE;
2324 /* This should be a fixed size alignment. */
2325 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (align_rtx) == CONST_INT);
2327 align = INTVAL (align_rtx);
2329 /* Anything to move? */
2330 bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
2331 if (bytes <= 0)
2332 return TRUE;
2334 /* Don't support real large clears. */
2335 if (bytes > TOTAL_MOVE_REG*align)
2336 return FALSE;
2338 /* Move the address into a scratch register. */
2339 dest_reg = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dest, 0));
2341 num_reg = offset = 0;
2342 for ( ; bytes > 0; (bytes -= clear_bytes), (offset += clear_bytes))
2344 /* Calculate the correct offset for src/dest. */
2345 dest_addr = ((offset == 0)
2346 ? dest_reg
2347 : plus_constant (dest_reg, offset));
2349 /* Generate the appropriate store of gr0. */
2350 if (bytes >= 4 && align >= 4)
2351 mode = SImode;
2352 else if (bytes >= 2 && align >= 2)
2353 mode = HImode;
2354 else
2355 mode = QImode;
2357 clear_bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2358 dest_mem = change_address (orig_dest, mode, dest_addr);
2359 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_mem, const0_rtx));
2362 return TRUE;
2366 /* The following variable is used to output modifiers of assembler
2367 code of the current output insn. */
2369 static rtx *frv_insn_operands;
2371 /* The following function is used to add assembler insn code suffix .p
2372 if it is necessary. */
2374 const char *
2375 frv_asm_output_opcode (FILE *f, const char *ptr)
2377 int c;
2379 if (frv_insn_packing_flag <= 0)
2380 return ptr;
2382 for (; *ptr && *ptr != ' ' && *ptr != '\t';)
2384 c = *ptr++;
2385 if (c == '%' && ((*ptr >= 'a' && *ptr <= 'z')
2386 || (*ptr >= 'A' && *ptr <= 'Z')))
2388 int letter = *ptr++;
2390 c = atoi (ptr);
2391 frv_print_operand (f, frv_insn_operands [c], letter);
2392 while ((c = *ptr) >= '0' && c <= '9')
2393 ptr++;
2395 else
2396 fputc (c, f);
2399 fprintf (f, ".p");
2401 return ptr;
2404 /* Set up the packing bit for the current output insn. Note that this
2405 function is not called for asm insns. */
2407 void
2408 frv_final_prescan_insn (rtx insn, rtx *opvec,
2409 int noperands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2411 if (INSN_P (insn))
2413 if (frv_insn_packing_flag >= 0)
2415 frv_insn_operands = opvec;
2416 frv_insn_packing_flag = PACKING_FLAG_P (insn);
2418 else if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0
2419 && get_attr_acc_group (insn) == ACC_GROUP_ODD)
2420 /* Packing optimizations have been disabled, but INSN can only
2421 be issued in M1. Insert an mnop in M0. */
2422 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmnop.p\n");
2428 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack frame
2429 where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that FRAMEADDR is
2430 an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame itself.
2432 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value of
2433 FRAMEADDR--that is, the stack frame address is also the address of the stack
2434 word that points to the previous frame. */
2436 /* The default is correct, but we need to make sure the frame gets created. */
2438 frv_dynamic_chain_address (rtx frame)
2440 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2441 return frame;
2445 /* A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2446 address for the frame COUNT steps up from the current frame, after the
2447 prologue. FRAMEADDR is the frame pointer of the COUNT frame, or the frame
2448 pointer of the COUNT - 1 frame if `RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME' is
2449 defined.
2451 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when COUNT is
2452 zero, but may be `NULL_RTX' if there is not way to determine the return
2453 address of other frames. */
2456 frv_return_addr_rtx (int count, rtx frame)
2458 if (count != 0)
2459 return const0_rtx;
2460 cfun->machine->frame_needed = 1;
2461 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (frame, 8));
2464 /* Given a memory reference MEMREF, interpret the referenced memory as
2465 an array of MODE values, and return a reference to the element
2466 specified by INDEX. Assume that any pre-modification implicit in
2467 MEMREF has already happened.
2469 MEMREF must be a legitimate operand for modes larger than SImode.
2470 GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS forbids register+register addresses, which
2471 this function cannot handle. */
2473 frv_index_memory (rtx memref, enum machine_mode mode, int index)
2475 rtx base = XEXP (memref, 0);
2476 if (GET_CODE (base) == PRE_MODIFY)
2477 base = XEXP (base, 0);
2478 return change_address (memref, mode,
2479 plus_constant (base, index * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)));
2483 /* Print a memory address as an operand to reference that memory location. */
2484 void
2485 frv_print_operand_address (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2487 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2488 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2490 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2492 case REG:
2493 fputs (reg_names [ REGNO (x)], stream);
2494 return;
2496 case CONST_INT:
2497 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) INTVAL (x));
2498 return;
2500 case SYMBOL_REF:
2501 assemble_name (stream, XSTR (x, 0));
2502 return;
2504 case LABEL_REF:
2505 case CONST:
2506 output_addr_const (stream, x);
2507 return;
2509 default:
2510 break;
2513 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_address:", x);
2517 static void
2518 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (FILE * stream, rtx x)
2520 int regno = true_regnum (x);
2521 if (GPR_P (regno))
2522 fputs (reg_names[regno], stream);
2523 else
2524 fatal_insn ("Bad register to frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg:", x);
2527 /* Print a memory reference suitable for the ld/st instructions. */
2529 static void
2530 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (FILE * stream, rtx x, int addr_offset)
2532 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2533 rtx x0 = NULL_RTX;
2534 rtx x1 = NULL_RTX;
2536 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2538 case SUBREG:
2539 case REG:
2540 x0 = x;
2541 break;
2543 case PRE_MODIFY: /* (pre_modify (reg) (plus (reg) (reg))) */
2544 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2545 x1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
2546 break;
2548 case CONST_INT:
2549 x1 = x;
2550 break;
2552 case PLUS:
2553 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
2554 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
2555 if (GET_CODE (x0) == CONST_INT)
2557 x0 = XEXP (x, 1);
2558 x1 = XEXP (x, 0);
2560 break;
2562 default:
2563 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2564 break;
2568 if (addr_offset)
2570 if (!x1)
2571 x1 = const0_rtx;
2572 else if (GET_CODE (x1) != CONST_INT)
2573 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2576 fputs ("@(", stream);
2577 if (!x0)
2578 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], stream);
2579 else if (GET_CODE (x0) == REG || GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
2580 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x0);
2581 else
2582 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2584 fputs (",", stream);
2585 if (!x1)
2586 fputs (reg_names [GPR_R0], stream);
2588 else
2590 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
2592 case SUBREG:
2593 case REG:
2594 frv_print_operand_memory_reference_reg (stream, x1);
2595 break;
2597 case CONST_INT:
2598 fprintf (stream, "%ld", (long) (INTVAL (x1) + addr_offset));
2599 break;
2601 case CONST:
2602 if (!frv_const_unspec_p (x1, &unspec))
2603 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x1);
2604 frv_output_const_unspec (stream, &unspec);
2605 break;
2607 default:
2608 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand_memory_reference:", x);
2612 fputs (")", stream);
2616 /* Return 2 for likely branches and 0 for non-likely branches */
2618 #define FRV_JUMP_LIKELY 2
2619 #define FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY 0
2621 static int
2622 frv_print_operand_jump_hint (rtx insn)
2624 rtx note;
2625 rtx labelref;
2626 int ret;
2627 HOST_WIDE_INT prob = -1;
2628 enum { UNKNOWN, BACKWARD, FORWARD } jump_type = UNKNOWN;
2630 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN);
2632 /* Assume any non-conditional jump is likely. */
2633 if (! any_condjump_p (insn))
2634 ret = FRV_JUMP_LIKELY;
2636 else
2638 labelref = condjump_label (insn);
2639 if (labelref)
2641 rtx label = XEXP (labelref, 0);
2642 jump_type = (insn_current_address > INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (label))
2643 ? BACKWARD
2644 : FORWARD);
2647 note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_BR_PROB, 0);
2648 if (!note)
2649 ret = ((jump_type == BACKWARD) ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2651 else
2653 prob = INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0));
2654 ret = ((prob >= (REG_BR_PROB_BASE / 2))
2655 ? FRV_JUMP_LIKELY
2656 : FRV_JUMP_NOT_LIKELY);
2660 #if 0
2661 if (TARGET_DEBUG)
2663 char *direction;
2665 switch (jump_type)
2667 default:
2668 case UNKNOWN: direction = "unknown jump direction"; break;
2669 case BACKWARD: direction = "jump backward"; break;
2670 case FORWARD: direction = "jump forward"; break;
2673 fprintf (stderr,
2674 "%s: uid %ld, %s, probability = %ld, max prob. = %ld, hint = %d\n",
2675 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (current_function_decl)),
2676 (long)INSN_UID (insn), direction, (long)prob,
2677 (long)REG_BR_PROB_BASE, ret);
2679 #endif
2681 return ret;
2685 /* Return the comparison operator to use for CODE given that the ICC
2686 register is OP0. */
2688 static const char *
2689 comparison_string (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0)
2691 bool is_nz_p = GET_MODE (op0) == CC_NZmode;
2692 switch (code)
2694 default: output_operand_lossage ("bad condition code");
2695 case EQ: return "eq";
2696 case NE: return "ne";
2697 case LT: return is_nz_p ? "n" : "lt";
2698 case LE: return "le";
2699 case GT: return "gt";
2700 case GE: return is_nz_p ? "p" : "ge";
2701 case LTU: return is_nz_p ? "no" : "c";
2702 case LEU: return is_nz_p ? "eq" : "ls";
2703 case GTU: return is_nz_p ? "ne" : "hi";
2704 case GEU: return is_nz_p ? "ra" : "nc";
2708 /* Print an operand to an assembler instruction.
2710 `%' followed by a letter and a digit says to output an operand in an
2711 alternate fashion. Four letters have standard, built-in meanings described
2712 below. The machine description macro `PRINT_OPERAND' can define additional
2713 letters with nonstandard meanings.
2715 `%cDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand that is a constant value
2716 without the syntax that normally indicates an immediate operand.
2718 `%nDIGIT' is like `%cDIGIT' except that the value of the constant is negated
2719 before printing.
2721 `%aDIGIT' can be used to substitute an operand as if it were a memory
2722 reference, with the actual operand treated as the address. This may be
2723 useful when outputting a "load address" instruction, because often the
2724 assembler syntax for such an instruction requires you to write the operand
2725 as if it were a memory reference.
2727 `%lDIGIT' is used to substitute a `label_ref' into a jump instruction.
2729 `%=' outputs a number which is unique to each instruction in the entire
2730 compilation. This is useful for making local labels to be referred to more
2731 than once in a single template that generates multiple assembler
2732 instructions.
2734 `%' followed by a punctuation character specifies a substitution that does
2735 not use an operand. Only one case is standard: `%%' outputs a `%' into the
2736 assembler code. Other nonstandard cases can be defined in the
2737 `PRINT_OPERAND' macro. You must also define which punctuation characters
2738 are valid with the `PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P' macro. */
2740 void
2741 frv_print_operand (FILE * file, rtx x, int code)
2743 struct frv_unspec unspec;
2744 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
2745 int offset;
2747 if (code != 0 && !isalpha (code))
2748 value = 0;
2750 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2751 value = INTVAL (x);
2753 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2755 if (GET_MODE (x) == SFmode)
2757 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
2758 long l;
2760 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, x);
2761 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
2762 value = l;
2765 else if (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
2766 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
2768 else
2769 fatal_insn ("Bad insn in frv_print_operand, bad const_double", x);
2772 else
2773 value = 0;
2775 switch (code)
2778 case '.':
2779 /* Output r0. */
2780 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2781 break;
2783 case '#':
2784 fprintf (file, "%d", frv_print_operand_jump_hint (current_output_insn));
2785 break;
2787 case '@':
2788 /* Output small data area base register (gr16). */
2789 fputs (reg_names[SDA_BASE_REG], file);
2790 break;
2792 case '~':
2793 /* Output pic register (gr17). */
2794 fputs (reg_names[PIC_REGNO], file);
2795 break;
2797 case '*':
2798 /* Output the temporary integer CCR register. */
2799 fputs (reg_names[ICR_TEMP], file);
2800 break;
2802 case '&':
2803 /* Output the temporary integer CC register. */
2804 fputs (reg_names[ICC_TEMP], file);
2805 break;
2807 /* case 'a': print an address. */
2809 case 'C':
2810 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch false operation. */
2811 fputs (comparison_string (reverse_condition (GET_CODE (x)),
2812 XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2813 break;
2815 case 'c':
2816 /* Print appropriate test for integer branch true operation. */
2817 fputs (comparison_string (GET_CODE (x), XEXP (x, 0)), file);
2818 break;
2820 case 'e':
2821 /* Print 1 for a NE and 0 for an EQ to give the final argument
2822 for a conditional instruction. */
2823 if (GET_CODE (x) == NE)
2824 fputs ("1", file);
2826 else if (GET_CODE (x) == EQ)
2827 fputs ("0", file);
2829 else
2830 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'e' modifier:", x);
2831 break;
2833 case 'F':
2834 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch false operation. */
2835 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2837 default:
2838 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'F' modifier:", x);
2840 case EQ: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2841 case NE: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2842 case LT: fputs ("uge", file); break;
2843 case LE: fputs ("ug", file); break;
2844 case GT: fputs ("ule", file); break;
2845 case GE: fputs ("ul", file); break;
2847 break;
2849 case 'f':
2850 /* Print appropriate test for floating point branch true operation. */
2851 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2853 default:
2854 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'f' modifier:", x);
2856 case EQ: fputs ("eq", file); break;
2857 case NE: fputs ("ne", file); break;
2858 case LT: fputs ("lt", file); break;
2859 case LE: fputs ("le", file); break;
2860 case GT: fputs ("gt", file); break;
2861 case GE: fputs ("ge", file); break;
2863 break;
2865 case 'g':
2866 /* Print appropriate GOT function. */
2867 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2868 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'g' modifier:", x);
2869 fputs (unspec_got_name (INTVAL (x)), file);
2870 break;
2872 case 'I':
2873 /* Print 'i' if the operand is a constant, or is a memory reference that
2874 adds a constant. */
2875 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
2876 x = ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
2877 ? XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)
2878 : XEXP (x, 0));
2879 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
2880 x = XEXP (x, 1);
2882 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2884 default:
2885 break;
2887 case CONST_INT:
2888 case SYMBOL_REF:
2889 case CONST:
2890 fputs ("i", file);
2891 break;
2893 break;
2895 case 'i':
2896 /* For jump instructions, print 'i' if the operand is a constant or
2897 is an expression that adds a constant. */
2898 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
2899 fputs ("i", file);
2901 else
2903 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
2904 || (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2905 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2906 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)))
2907 fputs ("i", file);
2909 break;
2911 case 'L':
2912 /* Print the lower register of a double word register pair */
2913 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2914 fputs (reg_names[ REGNO (x)+1 ], file);
2915 else
2916 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'L' modifier:", x);
2917 break;
2919 /* case 'l': print a LABEL_REF. */
2921 case 'M':
2922 case 'N':
2923 /* Print a memory reference for ld/st/jmp, %N prints a memory reference
2924 for the second word of double memory operations. */
2925 offset = (code == 'M') ? 0 : UNITS_PER_WORD;
2926 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2928 default:
2929 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'M/N' modifier:", x);
2931 case MEM:
2932 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, XEXP (x, 0), offset);
2933 break;
2935 case REG:
2936 case SUBREG:
2937 case CONST_INT:
2938 case PLUS:
2939 case SYMBOL_REF:
2940 frv_print_operand_memory_reference (file, x, offset);
2941 break;
2943 break;
2945 case 'O':
2946 /* Print the opcode of a command. */
2947 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2949 default:
2950 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, 'O' modifier:", x);
2952 case PLUS: fputs ("add", file); break;
2953 case MINUS: fputs ("sub", file); break;
2954 case AND: fputs ("and", file); break;
2955 case IOR: fputs ("or", file); break;
2956 case XOR: fputs ("xor", file); break;
2957 case ASHIFT: fputs ("sll", file); break;
2958 case ASHIFTRT: fputs ("sra", file); break;
2959 case LSHIFTRT: fputs ("srl", file); break;
2961 break;
2963 /* case 'n': negate and print a constant int. */
2965 case 'P':
2966 /* Print PIC label using operand as the number. */
2967 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
2968 fatal_insn ("Bad insn to frv_print_operand, P modifier:", x);
2970 fprintf (file, ".LCF%ld", (long)INTVAL (x));
2971 break;
2973 case 'U':
2974 /* Print 'u' if the operand is a update load/store. */
2975 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
2976 fputs ("u", file);
2977 break;
2979 case 'z':
2980 /* If value is 0, print gr0, otherwise it must be a register. */
2981 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) == 0)
2982 fputs (reg_names[GPR_R0], file);
2984 else if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
2985 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
2987 else
2988 fatal_insn ("Bad insn in frv_print_operand, z case", x);
2989 break;
2991 case 'x':
2992 /* Print constant in hex. */
2993 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2995 fprintf (file, "%s0x%.4lx", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
2996 break;
2999 /* Fall through. */
3001 case '\0':
3002 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
3003 fputs (reg_names [REGNO (x)], file);
3005 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
3006 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
3007 fprintf (file, "%s%ld", IMMEDIATE_PREFIX, (long) value);
3009 else if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec))
3010 frv_output_const_unspec (file, &unspec);
3012 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
3013 frv_print_operand_address (file, XEXP (x, 0));
3015 else if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
3016 frv_print_operand_address (file, x);
3018 else
3019 fatal_insn ("Bad insn in frv_print_operand, 0 case", x);
3021 break;
3023 default:
3024 fatal_insn ("frv_print_operand: unknown code", x);
3025 break;
3028 return;
3032 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable CUM for the
3033 state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable has type
3034 `CUMULATIVE_ARGS'. The value of FNTYPE is the tree node for the data type
3035 of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args are to a
3036 compiler support library function. The value of INDIRECT is nonzero when
3037 processing an indirect call, for example a call through a function pointer.
3038 The value of INDIRECT is zero for a call to an explicitly named function, a
3039 library function call, or when `INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS' is used to find
3040 arguments for the function being compiled.
3042 When processing a call to a compiler support library function, LIBNAME
3043 identifies which one. It is a `symbol_ref' rtx which contains the name of
3044 the function, as a string. LIBNAME is 0 when an ordinary C function call is
3045 being processed. Thus, each time this macro is called, either LIBNAME or
3046 FNTYPE is nonzero, but never both of them at once. */
3048 void
3049 frv_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3050 tree fntype,
3051 rtx libname,
3052 tree fndecl,
3053 int incoming)
3055 *cum = FIRST_ARG_REGNUM;
3057 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3059 fprintf (stderr, "\ninit_cumulative_args:");
3060 if (!fndecl && fntype)
3061 fputs (" indirect", stderr);
3063 if (incoming)
3064 fputs (" incoming", stderr);
3066 if (fntype)
3068 tree ret_type = TREE_TYPE (fntype);
3069 fprintf (stderr, " return=%s,",
3070 tree_code_name[ (int)TREE_CODE (ret_type) ]);
3073 if (libname && GET_CODE (libname) == SYMBOL_REF)
3074 fprintf (stderr, " libname=%s", XSTR (libname, 0));
3076 if (cfun->returns_struct)
3077 fprintf (stderr, " return-struct");
3079 putc ('\n', stderr);
3084 /* Return true if we should pass an argument on the stack rather than
3085 in registers. */
3087 static bool
3088 frv_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
3090 if (mode == BLKmode)
3091 return true;
3092 if (type == NULL)
3093 return false;
3094 return AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type);
3097 /* If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits, of an
3098 argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3099 `PARM_BOUNDARY' is used for all arguments. */
3102 frv_function_arg_boundary (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3103 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3105 return BITS_PER_WORD;
3109 frv_function_arg (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3110 enum machine_mode mode,
3111 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3112 int named,
3113 int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3115 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3116 int arg_num = *cum;
3117 rtx ret;
3118 const char *debstr;
3120 /* Return a marker for use in the call instruction. */
3121 if (xmode == VOIDmode)
3123 ret = const0_rtx;
3124 debstr = "<0>";
3127 else if (arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
3129 ret = gen_rtx_REG (xmode, arg_num);
3130 debstr = reg_names[arg_num];
3133 else
3135 ret = NULL_RTX;
3136 debstr = "memory";
3139 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3140 fprintf (stderr,
3141 "function_arg: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d, arg = %s\n",
3142 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), debstr);
3144 return ret;
3148 /* A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable CUM to
3149 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values MODE, TYPE and
3150 NAMED describe that argument. Once this is done, the variable CUM is
3151 suitable for analyzing the *following* argument with `FUNCTION_ARG', etc.
3153 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed on
3154 the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space used
3155 for arguments without any special help. */
3157 void
3158 frv_function_arg_advance (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
3159 enum machine_mode mode,
3160 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3161 int named)
3163 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3164 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3165 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3166 int arg_num = *cum;
3168 *cum = arg_num + words;
3170 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG)
3171 fprintf (stderr,
3172 "function_adv: words = %2d, mode = %4s, named = %d, size = %3d\n",
3173 arg_num, GET_MODE_NAME (mode), named, words * UNITS_PER_WORD);
3177 /* A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an argument,
3178 must be put in registers. The value must be zero for arguments that are
3179 passed entirely in registers or that are entirely pushed on the stack.
3181 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in registers
3182 and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the first N words of
3183 arguments are passed in registers, and the rest on the stack. If a
3184 multi-word argument (a `double' or a structure) crosses that boundary, its
3185 first few words must be passed in registers and the rest must be pushed.
3186 This macro tells the compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words
3187 should go in registers.
3189 `FUNCTION_ARG' for these arguments should return the first register to be
3190 used by the caller for this argument; likewise `FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG', for
3191 the called function. */
3193 static int
3194 frv_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum, enum machine_mode mode,
3195 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3197 enum machine_mode xmode = (mode == BLKmode) ? SImode : mode;
3198 int bytes = GET_MODE_SIZE (xmode);
3199 int words = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3200 int arg_num = *cum;
3201 int ret;
3203 ret = ((arg_num <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM && arg_num + words > LAST_ARG_REGNUM+1)
3204 ? LAST_ARG_REGNUM - arg_num + 1
3205 : 0);
3206 ret *= UNITS_PER_WORD;
3208 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ARG && ret)
3209 fprintf (stderr, "frv_arg_partial_bytes: %d\n", ret);
3211 return ret;
3215 /* Return true if a register is ok to use as a base or index register. */
3217 static FRV_INLINE int
3218 frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (int regno, int strict_p)
3220 if (GPR_P (regno))
3221 return TRUE;
3223 if (strict_p)
3224 return (reg_renumber[regno] >= 0 && GPR_P (reg_renumber[regno]));
3226 if (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
3227 return TRUE;
3229 return (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3233 /* A C compound statement with a conditional `goto LABEL;' executed if X (an
3234 RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the target machine for a memory
3235 operand of mode MODE.
3237 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as subroutines for
3238 this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to understand.
3240 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a non-strict
3241 one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
3242 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
3243 considered a memory reference. In contexts where some kind of register is
3244 required, a pseudo-register with no hard register must be rejected.
3246 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
3247 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of register is
3248 required.
3250 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this macro
3251 define the macro `REG_OK_STRICT'. You should use an `#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT'
3252 conditional to define the strict variant in that case and the non-strict
3253 variant otherwise.
3255 Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one for
3256 base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically among the
3257 subroutines used to define `GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS'. Then only these
3258 subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher levels of macros may be
3259 the same whether strict or not.
3261 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a `symbol_ref' and an
3262 integer are stored inside a `const' RTX to mark them as constant.
3263 Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums specifically as
3264 legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply recognize any `const' as
3265 legitimate.
3267 Usually `PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS' is not prepared to handle constant sums that
3268 are not marked with `const'. It assumes that a naked `plus' indicates
3269 indexing. If so, then you *must* reject such naked constant sums as
3270 illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will be given to
3271 `PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS'.
3273 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on the
3274 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the macro
3275 `ENCODE_SECTION_INFO' to store the information into the `symbol_ref', and
3276 then check for it here. When you see a `const', you will have to look
3277 inside it to find the `symbol_ref' in order to determine the section.
3279 The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the beginning,
3280 with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate the new name
3281 in `saveable_obstack'. You will have to modify `ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF' to
3282 remove and decode the added text and output the name accordingly, and define
3283 `(* targetm.strip_name_encoding)' to access the original name string.
3285 You can check the information stored here into the `symbol_ref' in the
3286 definitions of the macros `GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS' and
3287 `PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS'. */
3290 frv_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode,
3291 rtx x,
3292 int strict_p,
3293 int condexec_p,
3294 int allow_double_reg_p)
3296 rtx x0, x1;
3297 int ret = 0;
3298 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
3299 unsigned regno0;
3301 if (FRV_SYMBOL_REF_TLS_P (x))
3302 return 0;
3304 switch (GET_CODE (x))
3306 default:
3307 break;
3309 case SUBREG:
3310 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
3311 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3312 break;
3314 /* Fall through. */
3316 case REG:
3317 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x), strict_p);
3318 break;
3320 case PRE_MODIFY:
3321 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3322 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3323 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG
3324 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x0), strict_p)
3325 || GET_CODE (x1) != PLUS
3326 || ! rtx_equal_p (x0, XEXP (x1, 0))
3327 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x1, 1)) != REG
3328 || ! frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (XEXP (x1, 1)), strict_p))
3329 break;
3331 ret = 1;
3332 break;
3334 case CONST_INT:
3335 /* 12 bit immediate */
3336 if (condexec_p)
3337 ret = FALSE;
3338 else
3340 ret = IN_RANGE_P (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047);
3342 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3343 address the second word. */
3344 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3345 ret = IN_RANGE_P (INTVAL (x) + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1,
3346 -2048, 2047);
3348 break;
3350 case PLUS:
3351 x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3352 x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3354 if (GET_CODE (x0) == SUBREG)
3355 x0 = SUBREG_REG (x0);
3357 if (GET_CODE (x0) != REG)
3358 break;
3360 regno0 = REGNO (x0);
3361 if (!frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (regno0, strict_p))
3362 break;
3364 switch (GET_CODE (x1))
3366 default:
3367 break;
3369 case SUBREG:
3370 x1 = SUBREG_REG (x1);
3371 if (GET_CODE (x1) != REG)
3372 break;
3374 /* Fall through. */
3376 case REG:
3377 /* Do not allow reg+reg addressing for modes > 1 word if we
3378 can't depend on having move double instructions. */
3379 if (!allow_double_reg_p && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3380 ret = FALSE;
3381 else
3382 ret = frv_regno_ok_for_base_p (REGNO (x1), strict_p);
3383 break;
3385 case CONST_INT:
3386 /* 12 bit immediate */
3387 if (condexec_p)
3388 ret = FALSE;
3389 else
3391 value = INTVAL (x1);
3392 ret = IN_RANGE_P (value, -2048, 2047);
3394 /* If we can't use load/store double operations, make sure we can
3395 address the second word. */
3396 if (ret && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
3397 ret = IN_RANGE_P (value + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1, -2048, 2047);
3399 break;
3401 case CONST:
3402 if (!condexec_p && got12_operand (x1, VOIDmode))
3403 ret = TRUE;
3404 break;
3407 break;
3410 if (TARGET_DEBUG_ADDR)
3412 fprintf (stderr, "\n========== GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS, mode = %s, result = %d, addresses are %sstrict%s\n",
3413 GET_MODE_NAME (mode), ret, (strict_p) ? "" : "not ",
3414 (condexec_p) ? ", inside conditional code" : "");
3415 debug_rtx (x);
3418 return ret;
3421 /* Given an ADDR, generate code to inline the PLT. */
3422 static rtx
3423 gen_inlined_tls_plt (rtx addr)
3425 rtx retval, dest;
3426 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, FDPIC_REG);
3429 dest = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3431 if (flag_pic == 1)
3434 -fpic version:
3436 lddi.p @(gr15, #gottlsdesc12(ADDR)), gr8
3437 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3439 emit_insn (gen_tls_lddi (dest, addr, picreg));
3441 else
3444 -fPIC version:
3446 sethi.p #gottlsdeschi(ADDR), gr8
3447 setlo #gottlsdesclo(ADDR), gr8
3448 ldd #tlsdesc(ADDR)@(gr15, gr8), gr8
3449 calll #gettlsoff(ADDR)@(gr8, gr0)
3451 rtx reguse = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3452 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (reguse, addr, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI)));
3453 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsdesc_ldd (dest, picreg, reguse, addr));
3456 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3457 emit_insn (gen_tls_indirect_call (retval, addr, dest, picreg));
3458 return retval;
3461 /* Emit a TLSMOFF or TLSMOFF12 offset, depending on -mTLS. Returns
3462 the destination address. */
3463 static rtx
3464 gen_tlsmoff (rtx addr, rtx reg)
3466 rtx dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3468 if (TARGET_BIG_TLS)
3470 /* sethi.p #tlsmoffhi(x), grA
3471 setlo #tlsmofflo(x), grA
3473 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3474 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3475 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3476 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3478 else
3480 /* addi grB, #tlsmoff12(x), grC
3481 -or-
3482 ld/st @(grB, #tlsmoff12(x)), grC
3484 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3485 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_i (dest, addr, reg,
3486 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFF12)));
3488 return dest;
3491 /* Generate code for a TLS address. */
3492 static rtx
3493 frv_legitimize_tls_address (rtx addr, enum tls_model model)
3495 rtx dest, tp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29);
3496 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, 15);
3498 switch (model)
3500 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
3501 if (flag_pic == 1)
3503 /* -fpic version.
3504 ldi @(gr15, #gottlsoff12(x)), gr5
3506 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3507 emit_insn (gen_tls_load_gottlsoff12 (dest, addr, picreg));
3508 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3510 else
3512 /* -fPIC or anything else.
3514 sethi.p #gottlsoffhi(x), gr14
3515 setlo #gottlsofflo(x), gr14
3516 ld #tlsoff(x)@(gr15, gr14), gr9
3518 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3519 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3520 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (tmp, addr,
3521 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI)));
3523 emit_insn (gen_tls_tlsoff_ld (dest, picreg, tmp, addr));
3524 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, dest);
3526 break;
3527 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
3529 rtx reg, retval;
3531 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3532 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (GEN_INT (0));
3533 else
3535 /* call #gettlsoff(0) */
3536 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3537 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, GEN_INT (0), picreg));
3540 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3541 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3542 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
3543 retval, tp)));
3545 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, reg);
3548 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3549 emit_insn (gen_tlsoff_hilo (dest, addr,
3550 GEN_INT (R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI)));
3551 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, reg);
3553 break;
3555 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
3556 dest = gen_tlsmoff (addr, gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 29));
3557 break;
3558 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
3560 rtx retval;
3562 if (TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3563 retval = gen_inlined_tls_plt (addr);
3564 else
3566 /* call #gettlsoff(x) */
3567 retval = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3568 emit_insn (gen_call_gettlsoff (retval, addr, picreg));
3570 dest = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, retval, tp);
3571 break;
3573 default:
3574 gcc_unreachable ();
3577 return dest;
3581 frv_legitimize_address (rtx x,
3582 rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3583 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3585 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3587 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
3588 if (model != 0)
3589 return frv_legitimize_tls_address (x, model);
3592 return NULL_RTX;
3595 /* Test whether a local function descriptor is canonical, i.e.,
3596 whether we can use FUNCDESC_GOTOFF to compute the address of the
3597 function. */
3599 static bool
3600 frv_local_funcdesc_p (rtx fnx)
3602 tree fn;
3603 enum symbol_visibility vis;
3604 bool ret;
3606 if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (fnx))
3607 return FALSE;
3609 fn = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (fnx);
3611 if (! fn)
3612 return FALSE;
3614 vis = DECL_VISIBILITY (fn);
3616 if (vis == VISIBILITY_PROTECTED)
3617 /* Private function descriptors for protected functions are not
3618 canonical. Temporarily change the visibility to global. */
3619 vis = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
3620 else if (flag_shlib)
3621 /* If we're already compiling for a shared library (that, unlike
3622 executables, can't assume that the existence of a definition
3623 implies local binding), we can skip the re-testing. */
3624 return TRUE;
3626 ret = default_binds_local_p_1 (fn, flag_pic);
3628 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = vis;
3630 return ret;
3633 /* Load the _gp symbol into DEST. SRC is supposed to be the FDPIC
3634 register. */
3637 frv_gen_GPsym2reg (rtx dest, rtx src)
3639 tree gp = get_identifier ("_gp");
3640 rtx gp_sym = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (gp));
3642 return gen_symGOT2reg (dest, gp_sym, src, GEN_INT (R_FRV_GOT12));
3645 static const char *
3646 unspec_got_name (int i)
3648 switch (i)
3650 case R_FRV_GOT12: return "got12";
3651 case R_FRV_GOTHI: return "gothi";
3652 case R_FRV_GOTLO: return "gotlo";
3653 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC: return "funcdesc";
3654 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12: return "gotfuncdesc12";
3655 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTHI: return "gotfuncdeschi";
3656 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTLO: return "gotfuncdesclo";
3657 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_VALUE: return "funcdescvalue";
3658 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12: return "gotofffuncdesc12";
3659 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFHI: return "gotofffuncdeschi";
3660 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofffuncdesclo";
3661 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12: return "gotoff12";
3662 case R_FRV_GOTOFFHI: return "gotoffhi";
3663 case R_FRV_GOTOFFLO: return "gotofflo";
3664 case R_FRV_GPREL12: return "gprel12";
3665 case R_FRV_GPRELHI: return "gprelhi";
3666 case R_FRV_GPRELLO: return "gprello";
3667 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_HI: return "gottlsoffhi";
3668 case R_FRV_GOTTLSOFF_LO: return "gottlsofflo";
3669 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFHI: return "tlsmoffhi";
3670 case R_FRV_TLSMOFFLO: return "tlsmofflo";
3671 case R_FRV_TLSMOFF12: return "tlsmoff12";
3672 case R_FRV_TLSDESCHI: return "tlsdeschi";
3673 case R_FRV_TLSDESCLO: return "tlsdesclo";
3674 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCHI: return "gottlsdeschi";
3675 case R_FRV_GOTTLSDESCLO: return "gottlsdesclo";
3676 default: gcc_unreachable ();
3680 /* Write the assembler syntax for UNSPEC to STREAM. Note that any offset
3681 is added inside the relocation operator. */
3683 static void
3684 frv_output_const_unspec (FILE *stream, const struct frv_unspec *unspec)
3686 fprintf (stream, "#%s(", unspec_got_name (unspec->reloc));
3687 output_addr_const (stream, plus_constant (unspec->symbol, unspec->offset));
3688 fputs (")", stream);
3691 /* Implement FIND_BASE_TERM. See whether ORIG_X represents #gprel12(foo)
3692 or #gotoff12(foo) for some small data symbol foo. If so, return foo,
3693 otherwise return ORIG_X. */
3696 frv_find_base_term (rtx x)
3698 struct frv_unspec unspec;
3700 if (frv_const_unspec_p (x, &unspec)
3701 && frv_small_data_reloc_p (unspec.symbol, unspec.reloc))
3702 return plus_constant (unspec.symbol, unspec.offset);
3704 return x;
3707 /* Return 1 if operand is a valid FRV address. CONDEXEC_P is true if
3708 the operand is used by a predicated instruction. */
3711 frv_legitimate_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int condexec_p)
3713 return ((GET_MODE (op) == mode || mode == VOIDmode)
3714 && GET_CODE (op) == MEM
3715 && frv_legitimate_address_p (mode, XEXP (op, 0),
3716 reload_completed, condexec_p, FALSE));
3719 void
3720 frv_expand_fdpic_call (rtx *operands, bool ret_value, bool sibcall)
3722 rtx lr = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNO);
3723 rtx picreg = get_hard_reg_initial_val (SImode, FDPIC_REG);
3724 rtx c, rvrtx=0;
3725 rtx addr;
3727 if (ret_value)
3729 rvrtx = operands[0];
3730 operands ++;
3733 addr = XEXP (operands[0], 0);
3735 /* Inline PLTs if we're optimizing for speed. We'd like to inline
3736 any calls that would involve a PLT, but can't tell, since we
3737 don't know whether an extern function is going to be provided by
3738 a separate translation unit or imported from a separate module.
3739 When compiling for shared libraries, if the function has default
3740 visibility, we assume it's overridable, so we inline the PLT, but
3741 for executables, we don't really have a way to make a good
3742 decision: a function is as likely to be imported from a shared
3743 library as it is to be defined in the executable itself. We
3744 assume executables will get global functions defined locally,
3745 whereas shared libraries will have them potentially overridden,
3746 so we only inline PLTs when compiling for shared libraries.
3748 In order to mark a function as local to a shared library, any
3749 non-default visibility attribute suffices. Unfortunately,
3750 there's no simple way to tag a function declaration as ``in a
3751 different module'', which we could then use to trigger PLT
3752 inlining on executables. There's -minline-plt, but it affects
3753 all external functions, so one would have to also mark function
3754 declarations available in the same module with non-default
3755 visibility, which is advantageous in itself. */
3756 if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF
3757 && ((!SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (addr) && TARGET_INLINE_PLT)
3758 || sibcall))
3760 rtx x, dest;
3761 dest = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3762 if (flag_pic != 1)
3763 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3764 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3765 else
3766 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, addr, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
3767 GEN_INT (R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12));
3768 emit_insn (x);
3769 cfun->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
3770 addr = dest;
3772 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
3774 /* These are always either local, or handled through a local
3775 PLT. */
3776 if (ret_value)
3777 c = gen_call_value_fdpicsi (rvrtx, addr, operands[1],
3778 operands[2], picreg, lr);
3779 else
3780 c = gen_call_fdpicsi (addr, operands[1], operands[2], picreg, lr);
3781 emit_call_insn (c);
3782 return;
3784 else if (! ldd_address_operand (addr, Pmode))
3785 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
3787 picreg = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3788 emit_insn (gen_movdi_ldd (picreg, addr));
3790 if (sibcall && ret_value)
3791 c = gen_sibcall_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx);
3792 else if (sibcall)
3793 c = gen_sibcall_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx);
3794 else if (ret_value)
3795 c = gen_call_value_fdpicdi (rvrtx, picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3796 else
3797 c = gen_call_fdpicdi (picreg, const0_rtx, lr);
3798 emit_call_insn (c);
3801 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF of a function in an rtx. We always want to
3802 process these separately from any offsets, such that we add any
3803 offsets to the function descriptor (the actual pointer), not to the
3804 function address. */
3806 static bool
3807 frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (rtx x)
3809 const char *format;
3810 int length;
3811 int j;
3813 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
3814 return SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (x);
3816 length = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x));
3817 format = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
3819 for (j = 0; j < length; ++j)
3821 switch (format[j])
3823 case 'e':
3824 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (x, j)))
3825 return TRUE;
3826 break;
3828 case 'V':
3829 case 'E':
3830 if (XVEC (x, j) != 0)
3832 int k;
3833 for (k = 0; k < XVECLEN (x, j); ++k)
3834 if (frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XVECEXP (x, j, k)))
3835 return TRUE;
3837 break;
3839 default:
3840 /* Nothing to do. */
3841 break;
3845 return FALSE;
3848 /* Return true if the memory operand is one that can be conditionally
3849 executed. */
3852 condexec_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
3854 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (op);
3855 rtx addr;
3857 if (mode != VOIDmode && op_mode != mode)
3858 return FALSE;
3860 switch (op_mode)
3862 default:
3863 return FALSE;
3865 case QImode:
3866 case HImode:
3867 case SImode:
3868 case SFmode:
3869 break;
3872 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM)
3873 return FALSE;
3875 addr = XEXP (op, 0);
3876 return frv_legitimate_address_p (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE);
3879 /* Return true if the bare return instruction can be used outside of the
3880 epilog code. For frv, we only do it if there was no stack allocation. */
3883 direct_return_p (void)
3885 frv_stack_t *info;
3887 if (!reload_completed)
3888 return FALSE;
3890 info = frv_stack_info ();
3891 return (info->total_size == 0);
3895 void
3896 frv_emit_move (enum machine_mode mode, rtx dest, rtx src)
3898 if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF)
3900 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (src);
3901 if (model != 0)
3902 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
3905 switch (mode)
3907 case SImode:
3908 if (frv_emit_movsi (dest, src))
3909 return;
3910 break;
3912 case QImode:
3913 case HImode:
3914 case DImode:
3915 case SFmode:
3916 case DFmode:
3917 if (!reload_in_progress
3918 && !reload_completed
3919 && !register_operand (dest, mode)
3920 && !reg_or_0_operand (src, mode))
3921 src = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, src);
3922 break;
3924 default:
3925 gcc_unreachable ();
3928 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src));
3931 /* Emit code to handle a MOVSI, adding in the small data register or pic
3932 register if needed to load up addresses. Return TRUE if the appropriate
3933 instructions are emitted. */
3936 frv_emit_movsi (rtx dest, rtx src)
3938 int base_regno = -1;
3939 int unspec = 0;
3940 rtx sym = src;
3941 struct frv_unspec old_unspec;
3943 if (!reload_in_progress
3944 && !reload_completed
3945 && !register_operand (dest, SImode)
3946 && (!reg_or_0_operand (src, SImode)
3947 /* Virtual registers will almost always be replaced by an
3948 add instruction, so expose this to CSE by copying to
3949 an intermediate register. */
3950 || (GET_CODE (src) == REG
3951 && IN_RANGE_P (REGNO (src),
3952 FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER,
3953 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER))))
3955 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, src)));
3956 return TRUE;
3959 /* Explicitly add in the PIC or small data register if needed. */
3960 switch (GET_CODE (src))
3962 default:
3963 break;
3965 case LABEL_REF:
3966 handle_label:
3967 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
3969 /* Using GPREL12, we use a single GOT entry for all symbols
3970 in read-only sections, but trade sequences such as:
3972 sethi #gothi(label), gr#
3973 setlo #gotlo(label), gr#
3974 ld @(gr15,gr#), gr#
3978 ld @(gr15,#got12(_gp)), gr#
3979 sethi #gprelhi(label), gr##
3980 setlo #gprello(label), gr##
3981 add gr#, gr##, gr##
3983 We may often be able to share gr# for multiple
3984 computations of GPREL addresses, and we may often fold
3985 the final add into the pair of registers of a load or
3986 store instruction, so it's often profitable. Even when
3987 optimizing for size, we're trading a GOT entry for an
3988 additional instruction, which trades GOT space
3989 (read-write) for code size (read-only, shareable), as
3990 long as the symbol is not used in more than two different
3991 locations.
3993 With -fpie/-fpic, we'd be trading a single load for a
3994 sequence of 4 instructions, because the offset of the
3995 label can't be assumed to be addressable with 12 bits, so
3996 we don't do this. */
3997 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
3998 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
3999 else
4000 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4002 else if (flag_pic)
4003 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4005 break;
4007 case CONST:
4008 if (frv_const_unspec_p (src, &old_unspec))
4009 break;
4011 if (TARGET_FDPIC && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (XEXP (src, 0)))
4013 handle_whatever:
4014 src = force_reg (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), XEXP (src, 0));
4015 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4016 return TRUE;
4018 else
4020 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4021 if (GET_CODE (sym) == PLUS
4022 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
4023 && GET_CODE (XEXP (sym, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4024 sym = XEXP (sym, 0);
4025 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF)
4026 goto handle_sym;
4027 else if (GET_CODE (sym) == LABEL_REF)
4028 goto handle_label;
4029 else
4030 goto handle_whatever;
4032 break;
4034 case SYMBOL_REF:
4035 handle_sym:
4036 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
4038 enum tls_model model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (sym);
4040 if (model != 0)
4042 src = frv_legitimize_tls_address (src, model);
4043 emit_move_insn (dest, src);
4044 return TRUE;
4047 if (SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (sym))
4049 if (frv_local_funcdesc_p (sym))
4050 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12;
4051 else
4052 unspec = R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOT12;
4054 else
4056 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (sym))
4057 switch (GET_CODE (get_pool_constant (sym)))
4059 case CONST:
4060 case SYMBOL_REF:
4061 case LABEL_REF:
4062 if (flag_pic)
4064 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4065 break;
4067 /* Fall through. */
4068 default:
4069 if (TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4070 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4071 else
4072 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4073 break;
4075 else if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (sym)
4076 && !SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (sym)
4077 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym)
4078 && (!DECL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))
4079 || !DECL_COMMON (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym))))
4081 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (sym);
4082 tree init = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4083 ? DECL_INITIAL (decl)
4084 : TREE_CODE (decl) == CONSTRUCTOR
4085 ? decl : 0;
4086 int reloc = 0;
4087 bool named_section, readonly;
4089 if (init && init != error_mark_node)
4090 reloc = compute_reloc_for_constant (init);
4092 named_section = TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
4093 && lookup_attribute ("section", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl));
4094 readonly = decl_readonly_section (decl, reloc);
4096 if (named_section)
4097 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4098 else if (!readonly)
4099 unspec = R_FRV_GOTOFF12;
4100 else if (readonly && TARGET_GPREL_RO)
4101 unspec = R_FRV_GPREL12;
4102 else
4103 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4105 else
4106 unspec = R_FRV_GOT12;
4110 else if (SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4111 base_regno = SDA_BASE_REG;
4113 else if (flag_pic)
4114 base_regno = PIC_REGNO;
4116 break;
4119 if (base_regno >= 0)
4121 if (GET_CODE (sym) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (sym))
4122 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src,
4123 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4124 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4125 else
4126 emit_insn (gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src,
4127 gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, base_regno),
4128 GEN_INT (R_FRV_GPREL12)));
4129 if (base_regno == PIC_REGNO)
4130 cfun->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4131 return TRUE;
4134 if (unspec)
4136 rtx x;
4138 /* Since OUR_FDPIC_REG is a pseudo register, we can't safely introduce
4139 new uses of it once reload has begun. */
4140 gcc_assert (!reload_in_progress && !reload_completed);
4142 switch (unspec)
4144 case R_FRV_GOTOFF12:
4145 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4146 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4147 GEN_INT (unspec));
4148 else
4149 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4150 break;
4151 case R_FRV_GPREL12:
4152 if (!frv_small_data_reloc_p (sym, unspec))
4153 x = gen_symGPREL2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4154 GEN_INT (unspec));
4155 else
4156 x = gen_symGPREL2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4157 break;
4158 case R_FRV_FUNCDESC_GOTOFF12:
4159 if (flag_pic != 1)
4160 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4161 GEN_INT (unspec));
4162 else
4163 x = gen_symGOTOFF2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4164 break;
4165 default:
4166 if (flag_pic != 1)
4167 x = gen_symGOT2reg_hilo (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG,
4168 GEN_INT (unspec));
4169 else
4170 x = gen_symGOT2reg (dest, src, OUR_FDPIC_REG, GEN_INT (unspec));
4171 break;
4173 emit_insn (x);
4174 cfun->uses_pic_offset_table = TRUE;
4175 return TRUE;
4179 return FALSE;
4183 /* Return a string to output a single word move. */
4185 const char *
4186 output_move_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4188 rtx dest = operands[0];
4189 rtx src = operands[1];
4191 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4193 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4194 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4196 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4198 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4200 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4201 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4203 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4204 return "mov %1, %0";
4206 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4207 return "movfg %1, %0";
4209 else if (SPR_P (src_regno))
4210 return "movsg %1, %0";
4213 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4215 /* gpr <- memory */
4216 switch (mode)
4218 default:
4219 break;
4221 case QImode:
4222 return "ldsb%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4224 case HImode:
4225 return "ldsh%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4227 case SImode:
4228 case SFmode:
4229 return "ld%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4233 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4234 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4236 /* gpr <- integer/floating constant */
4237 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
4239 if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT)
4240 value = INTVAL (src);
4242 else if (mode == SFmode)
4244 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
4245 long l;
4247 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, src);
4248 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, l);
4249 value = l;
4252 else
4253 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (src);
4255 if (IN_RANGE_P (value, -32768, 32767))
4256 return "setlos %1, %0";
4258 return "#";
4261 else if (GET_CODE (src) == SYMBOL_REF
4262 || GET_CODE (src) == LABEL_REF
4263 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST)
4265 return "#";
4269 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4271 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4273 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4274 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4276 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4277 return "movgf %1, %0";
4279 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4281 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4282 return "fmovs %1, %0";
4283 else
4284 return "mor %1, %1, %0";
4288 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4290 /* fpr <- memory */
4291 switch (mode)
4293 default:
4294 break;
4296 case QImode:
4297 return "ldbf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4299 case HImode:
4300 return "ldhf%I1%U1 %M1,%0";
4302 case SImode:
4303 case SFmode:
4304 return "ldf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4308 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4309 return "movgf %., %0";
4312 else if (SPR_P (dest_regno))
4314 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4316 /* spr <- some sort of register */
4317 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4319 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4320 return "movgs %1, %0";
4322 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4323 return "movgs %., %0";
4327 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4329 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4331 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4332 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4334 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4336 switch (mode)
4338 default:
4339 break;
4341 case QImode:
4342 return "stb%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4344 case HImode:
4345 return "sth%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4347 case SImode:
4348 case SFmode:
4349 return "st%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4353 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4355 switch (mode)
4357 default:
4358 break;
4360 case QImode:
4361 return "stbf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4363 case HImode:
4364 return "sthf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4366 case SImode:
4367 case SFmode:
4368 return "stf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4373 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4375 switch (GET_MODE (dest))
4377 default:
4378 break;
4380 case QImode:
4381 return "stb%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4383 case HImode:
4384 return "sth%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4386 case SImode:
4387 case SFmode:
4388 return "st%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4393 fatal_insn ("Bad output_move_single operand", insn);
4394 return "";
4398 /* Return a string to output a double word move. */
4400 const char *
4401 output_move_double (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4403 rtx dest = operands[0];
4404 rtx src = operands[1];
4405 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4407 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4409 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4411 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4413 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4415 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4416 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4418 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4419 return "#";
4421 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4423 if (((dest_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4424 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4425 return "movfgd %1, %0";
4427 return "#";
4431 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4433 /* gpr <- memory */
4434 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4435 return "ldd%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4437 return "#";
4440 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
4441 || GET_CODE (src) == CONST_DOUBLE)
4442 return "#";
4445 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4447 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4449 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4450 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4452 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4454 if (((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4455 && ((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4456 return "movgfd %1, %0";
4458 return "#";
4461 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4463 if (TARGET_DOUBLE
4464 && ((dest_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4465 && ((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0)
4466 return "fmovd %1, %0";
4468 return "#";
4472 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4474 /* fpr <- memory */
4475 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (src, mode))
4476 return "lddf%I1%U1 %M1, %0";
4478 return "#";
4481 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4482 return "#";
4486 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4488 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4490 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4492 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4494 if (((src_regno - GPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4495 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4496 return "std%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4498 return "#";
4501 if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4503 if (((src_regno - FPR_FIRST) & 1) == 0
4504 && dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4505 return "stdf%I0%U0 %1, %M0";
4507 return "#";
4511 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4513 if (dbl_memory_one_insn_operand (dest, mode))
4514 return "std%I0%U0 %., %M0";
4516 return "#";
4520 fatal_insn ("Bad output_move_double operand", insn);
4521 return "";
4525 /* Return a string to output a single word conditional move.
4526 Operand0 -- EQ/NE of ccr register and 0
4527 Operand1 -- CCR register
4528 Operand2 -- destination
4529 Operand3 -- source */
4531 const char *
4532 output_condmove_single (rtx operands[], rtx insn)
4534 rtx dest = operands[2];
4535 rtx src = operands[3];
4537 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
4539 int dest_regno = REGNO (dest);
4540 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4542 if (GPR_P (dest_regno))
4544 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4546 /* gpr <- some sort of register */
4547 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4549 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4550 return "cmov %z3, %2, %1, %e0";
4552 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4553 return "cmovfg %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4556 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4558 /* gpr <- memory */
4559 switch (mode)
4561 default:
4562 break;
4564 case QImode:
4565 return "cldsb%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4567 case HImode:
4568 return "cldsh%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4570 case SImode:
4571 case SFmode:
4572 return "cld%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4576 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4577 return "cmov %., %2, %1, %e0";
4580 else if (FPR_P (dest_regno))
4582 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4584 /* fpr <- some sort of register */
4585 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4587 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4588 return "cmovgf %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4590 else if (FPR_P (src_regno))
4592 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
4593 return "cfmovs %3,%2,%1,%e0";
4594 else
4595 return "cmor %3, %3, %2, %1, %e0";
4599 else if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
4601 /* fpr <- memory */
4602 if (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode)
4603 return "cldf%I3%U3 %M3, %2, %1, %e0";
4606 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4607 return "cmovgf %., %2, %1, %e0";
4611 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
4613 if (GET_CODE (src) == REG)
4615 int src_regno = REGNO (src);
4616 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4618 if (GPR_P (src_regno))
4620 switch (mode)
4622 default:
4623 break;
4625 case QImode:
4626 return "cstb%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4628 case HImode:
4629 return "csth%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4631 case SImode:
4632 case SFmode:
4633 return "cst%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4637 else if (FPR_P (src_regno) && (mode == SImode || mode == SFmode))
4638 return "cstf%I2%U2 %3, %M2, %1, %e0";
4641 else if (ZERO_P (src))
4643 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4644 switch (mode)
4646 default:
4647 break;
4649 case QImode:
4650 return "cstb%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4652 case HImode:
4653 return "csth%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4655 case SImode:
4656 case SFmode:
4657 return "cst%I2%U2 %., %M2, %1, %e0";
4662 fatal_insn ("Bad output_condmove_single operand", insn);
4663 return "";
4667 /* Emit the appropriate code to do a comparison, returning the register the
4668 comparison was done it. */
4670 static rtx
4671 frv_emit_comparison (enum rtx_code test, rtx op0, rtx op1)
4673 enum machine_mode cc_mode;
4674 rtx cc_reg;
4676 /* Floating point doesn't have comparison against a constant. */
4677 if (GET_MODE (op0) == CC_FPmode && GET_CODE (op1) != REG)
4678 op1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op1);
4680 /* Possibly disable using anything but a fixed register in order to work
4681 around cse moving comparisons past function calls. */
4682 cc_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (test, op0, op1);
4683 cc_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4684 ? gen_reg_rtx (cc_mode)
4685 : gen_rtx_REG (cc_mode,
4686 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCC_FIRST : ICC_FIRST));
4688 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cc_reg,
4689 gen_rtx_COMPARE (cc_mode, op0, op1)));
4691 return cc_reg;
4695 /* Emit code for a conditional branch. The comparison operands were previously
4696 stored in frv_compare_op0 and frv_compare_op1.
4698 XXX: I originally wanted to add a clobber of a CCR register to use in
4699 conditional execution, but that confuses the rest of the compiler. */
4702 frv_emit_cond_branch (enum rtx_code test, rtx label)
4704 rtx test_rtx;
4705 rtx label_ref;
4706 rtx if_else;
4707 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, frv_compare_op0, frv_compare_op1);
4708 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4710 /* Branches generate:
4711 (set (pc)
4712 (if_then_else (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4713 (label_ref <branch_label>)
4714 (pc))) */
4715 label_ref = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode, label);
4716 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4717 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (cc_mode, test_rtx, label_ref, pc_rtx);
4718 emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, if_else));
4719 return TRUE;
4723 /* Emit code to set a gpr to 1/0 based on a comparison. The comparison
4724 operands were previously stored in frv_compare_op0 and frv_compare_op1. */
4727 frv_emit_scc (enum rtx_code test, rtx target)
4729 rtx set;
4730 rtx test_rtx;
4731 rtx clobber;
4732 rtx cr_reg;
4733 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, frv_compare_op0, frv_compare_op1);
4735 /* SCC instructions generate:
4736 (parallel [(set <target> (<test>, <cc_reg>, (const_int 0))
4737 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4738 test_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, SImode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4739 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, test_rtx);
4741 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4742 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4743 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4744 ((GET_MODE (cc_reg) == CC_FPmode)
4745 ? FCR_FIRST
4746 : ICR_FIRST)));
4748 clobber = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4749 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber)));
4750 return TRUE;
4754 /* Split a SCC instruction into component parts, returning a SEQUENCE to hold
4755 the separate insns. */
4758 frv_split_scc (rtx dest, rtx test, rtx cc_reg, rtx cr_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT value)
4760 rtx ret;
4762 start_sequence ();
4764 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4765 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4766 cr_reg,
4767 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4768 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4769 cc_reg,
4770 const0_rtx)));
4772 /* Move the value into the destination. */
4773 emit_move_insn (dest, GEN_INT (value));
4775 /* Move 0 into the destination if the test failed */
4776 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4777 gen_rtx_EQ (GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4778 cr_reg,
4779 const0_rtx),
4780 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, const0_rtx)));
4782 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4783 ret = get_insns ();
4784 end_sequence ();
4785 return ret;
4789 /* Emit the code for a conditional move, return TRUE if we could do the
4790 move. */
4793 frv_emit_cond_move (rtx dest, rtx test_rtx, rtx src1, rtx src2)
4795 rtx set;
4796 rtx clobber_cc;
4797 rtx test2;
4798 rtx cr_reg;
4799 rtx if_rtx;
4800 enum rtx_code test = GET_CODE (test_rtx);
4801 rtx cc_reg = frv_emit_comparison (test, frv_compare_op0, frv_compare_op1);
4802 enum machine_mode cc_mode = GET_MODE (cc_reg);
4804 /* Conditional move instructions generate:
4805 (parallel [(set <target>
4806 (if_then_else (<test> <cc_reg> (const_int 0))
4807 <src1>
4808 <src2>))
4809 (clobber (<ccr_reg>))]) */
4811 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4812 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4814 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4815 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4817 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4818 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4819 if (value1 == 0 || value2 == 0)
4822 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4823 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4824 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4825 value. */
4826 else if (IN_RANGE_P (value1, -2048, 2047)
4827 && IN_RANGE_P (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4830 /* If neither condition holds, just force the constant into a
4831 register. */
4832 else
4834 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4835 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4839 /* If one value is a register, insure the other value is either 0 or a
4840 register. */
4841 else
4843 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src1) != 0)
4844 src1 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src1);
4846 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
4847 src2 = force_reg (GET_MODE (dest), src2);
4850 test2 = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test, cc_mode, cc_reg, const0_rtx);
4851 if_rtx = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (GET_MODE (dest), test2, src1, src2);
4853 set = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_rtx);
4855 cr_reg = ((TARGET_ALLOC_CC)
4856 ? gen_reg_rtx (CC_CCRmode)
4857 : gen_rtx_REG (CC_CCRmode,
4858 (cc_mode == CC_FPmode) ? FCR_FIRST : ICR_FIRST));
4860 clobber_cc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, cr_reg);
4861 emit_insn (gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, gen_rtvec (2, set, clobber_cc)));
4862 return TRUE;
4866 /* Split a conditional move into constituent parts, returning a SEQUENCE
4867 containing all of the insns. */
4870 frv_split_cond_move (rtx operands[])
4872 rtx dest = operands[0];
4873 rtx test = operands[1];
4874 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
4875 rtx src1 = operands[3];
4876 rtx src2 = operands[4];
4877 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
4878 rtx ret;
4879 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
4881 start_sequence ();
4883 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
4884 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
4885 cr_reg,
4886 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test),
4887 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
4888 cc_reg,
4889 const0_rtx)));
4891 /* Handle various cases of conditional move involving two constants. */
4892 if (GET_CODE (src1) == CONST_INT && GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT)
4894 HOST_WIDE_INT value1 = INTVAL (src1);
4895 HOST_WIDE_INT value2 = INTVAL (src2);
4897 /* Having 0 as one of the constants can be done by loading the other
4898 constant, and optionally moving in gr0. */
4899 if (value1 == 0)
4901 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
4902 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4903 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4904 const0_rtx),
4905 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4908 else if (value2 == 0)
4910 emit_move_insn (dest, src1);
4911 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4912 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4913 const0_rtx),
4914 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4917 /* If the first value is within an addi range and also the difference
4918 between the two fits in an addi's range, load up the difference, then
4919 conditionally move in 0, and then unconditionally add the first
4920 value. */
4921 else if (IN_RANGE_P (value1, -2048, 2047)
4922 && IN_RANGE_P (value2 - value1, -2048, 2047))
4924 rtx dest_si = ((GET_MODE (dest) == SImode)
4925 ? dest
4926 : gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, dest, 0));
4928 emit_move_insn (dest_si, GEN_INT (value2 - value1));
4929 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4930 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg,
4931 const0_rtx),
4932 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest_si,
4933 const0_rtx)));
4934 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dest_si, dest_si, src1));
4937 else
4938 gcc_unreachable ();
4940 else
4942 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
4943 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
4944 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4945 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
4946 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
4948 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
4949 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
4950 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
4951 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
4952 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
4955 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
4956 ret = get_insns ();
4957 end_sequence ();
4958 return ret;
4962 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST is a double register and SOURCE is a
4963 memory location that is not known to be dword-aligned. */
4964 void
4965 frv_split_double_load (rtx dest, rtx source)
4967 int regno = REGNO (dest);
4968 rtx dest1 = gen_highpart (SImode, dest);
4969 rtx dest2 = gen_lowpart (SImode, dest);
4970 rtx address = XEXP (source, 0);
4972 /* If the address is pre-modified, load the lower-numbered register
4973 first, then load the other register using an integer offset from
4974 the modified base register. This order should always be safe,
4975 since the pre-modification cannot affect the same registers as the
4976 load does.
4978 The situation for other loads is more complicated. Loading one
4979 of the registers could affect the value of ADDRESS, so we must
4980 be careful which order we do them in. */
4981 if (GET_CODE (address) == PRE_MODIFY
4982 || ! refers_to_regno_p (regno, regno + 1, address, NULL))
4984 /* It is safe to load the lower-numbered register first. */
4985 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
4986 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
4988 else
4990 /* ADDRESS is not pre-modified and the address depends on the
4991 lower-numbered register. Load the higher-numbered register
4992 first. */
4993 emit_move_insn (dest2, frv_index_memory (source, SImode, 1));
4994 emit_move_insn (dest1, change_address (source, SImode, NULL));
4998 /* Split (set DEST SOURCE), where DEST refers to a dword memory location
4999 and SOURCE is either a double register or the constant zero. */
5000 void
5001 frv_split_double_store (rtx dest, rtx source)
5003 rtx dest1 = change_address (dest, SImode, NULL);
5004 rtx dest2 = frv_index_memory (dest, SImode, 1);
5005 if (ZERO_P (source))
5007 emit_move_insn (dest1, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5008 emit_move_insn (dest2, CONST0_RTX (SImode));
5010 else
5012 emit_move_insn (dest1, gen_highpart (SImode, source));
5013 emit_move_insn (dest2, gen_lowpart (SImode, source));
5018 /* Split a min/max operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5019 insns. */
5022 frv_split_minmax (rtx operands[])
5024 rtx dest = operands[0];
5025 rtx minmax = operands[1];
5026 rtx src1 = operands[2];
5027 rtx src2 = operands[3];
5028 rtx cc_reg = operands[4];
5029 rtx cr_reg = operands[5];
5030 rtx ret;
5031 enum rtx_code test_code;
5032 enum machine_mode cr_mode = GET_MODE (cr_reg);
5034 start_sequence ();
5036 /* Figure out which test to use. */
5037 switch (GET_CODE (minmax))
5039 default:
5040 gcc_unreachable ();
5042 case SMIN: test_code = LT; break;
5043 case SMAX: test_code = GT; break;
5044 case UMIN: test_code = LTU; break;
5045 case UMAX: test_code = GTU; break;
5048 /* Issue the compare instruction. */
5049 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5050 cc_reg,
5051 gen_rtx_COMPARE (GET_MODE (cc_reg),
5052 src1, src2)));
5054 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5055 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5056 cr_reg,
5057 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (test_code,
5058 GET_MODE (cr_reg),
5059 cc_reg,
5060 const0_rtx)));
5062 /* If are taking the min/max of a nonzero constant, load that first, and
5063 then do a conditional move of the other value. */
5064 if (GET_CODE (src2) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (src2) != 0)
5066 gcc_assert (!rtx_equal_p (dest, src1));
5068 emit_move_insn (dest, src2);
5069 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5070 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5071 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5074 /* Otherwise, do each half of the move. */
5075 else
5077 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being true if needed. */
5078 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src1))
5079 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5080 gen_rtx_NE (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5081 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src1)));
5083 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5084 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src2))
5085 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5086 gen_rtx_EQ (cr_mode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5087 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src2)));
5090 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5091 ret = get_insns ();
5092 end_sequence ();
5093 return ret;
5097 /* Split an integer abs operation returning a SEQUENCE containing all of the
5098 insns. */
5101 frv_split_abs (rtx operands[])
5103 rtx dest = operands[0];
5104 rtx src = operands[1];
5105 rtx cc_reg = operands[2];
5106 rtx cr_reg = operands[3];
5107 rtx ret;
5109 start_sequence ();
5111 /* Issue the compare < 0 instruction. */
5112 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5113 cc_reg,
5114 gen_rtx_COMPARE (CCmode, src, const0_rtx)));
5116 /* Set the appropriate CCR bit. */
5117 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
5118 cr_reg,
5119 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (LT, CC_CCRmode, cc_reg, const0_rtx)));
5121 /* Emit the conditional negate if the value is negative. */
5122 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5123 gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5124 gen_negsi2 (dest, src)));
5126 /* Emit the conditional move for the test being false if needed. */
5127 if (! rtx_equal_p (dest, src))
5128 emit_insn (gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode,
5129 gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr_reg, const0_rtx),
5130 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src)));
5132 /* Finish up, return sequence. */
5133 ret = get_insns ();
5134 end_sequence ();
5135 return ret;
5139 /* An internal function called by for_each_rtx to clear in a hard_reg set each
5140 register used in an insn. */
5142 static int
5143 frv_clear_registers_used (rtx *ptr, void *data)
5145 if (GET_CODE (*ptr) == REG)
5147 int regno = REGNO (*ptr);
5148 HARD_REG_SET *p_regs = (HARD_REG_SET *)data;
5150 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5152 int reg_max = regno + HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, GET_MODE (*ptr));
5154 while (regno < reg_max)
5156 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (*p_regs, regno);
5157 regno++;
5162 return 0;
5166 /* Initialize the extra fields provided by IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS. */
5168 /* On the FR-V, we don't have any extra fields per se, but it is useful hook to
5169 initialize the static storage. */
5170 void
5171 frv_ifcvt_init_extra_fields (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5173 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5174 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5175 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5176 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = NULL_RTX;
5177 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = NULL_RTX;
5178 frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr = NULL_RTX;
5179 frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr = NULL_RTX;
5180 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5184 /* Internal function to add a potential insn to the list of insns to be inserted
5185 if the conditional execution conversion is successful. */
5187 static void
5188 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (rtx pattern, rtx insn, int before_p)
5190 rtx link = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, pattern, insn);
5192 link->jump = before_p; /* Mark to add this before or after insn. */
5193 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = alloc_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, link,
5194 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list);
5196 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5198 fprintf (stderr,
5199 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_add_insn: add the following %s insn %d:\n",
5200 (before_p) ? "before" : "after",
5201 (int)INSN_UID (insn));
5203 debug_rtx (pattern);
5208 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5209 information CE_INFO, possibly updating the tests in TRUE_EXPR, and
5210 FALSE_EXPR for converting if-then and if-then-else code to conditional
5211 instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the
5212 tests cannot be converted. */
5214 void
5215 frv_ifcvt_modify_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info, rtx *p_true, rtx *p_false)
5217 basic_block test_bb = ce_info->test_bb; /* test basic block */
5218 basic_block then_bb = ce_info->then_bb; /* THEN */
5219 basic_block else_bb = ce_info->else_bb; /* ELSE or NULL */
5220 basic_block join_bb = ce_info->join_bb; /* join block or NULL */
5221 rtx true_expr = *p_true;
5222 rtx cr;
5223 rtx cc;
5224 rtx nested_cc;
5225 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5226 int j;
5227 basic_block *bb;
5228 int num_bb;
5229 frv_tmp_reg_t *tmp_reg = &frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg;
5230 rtx check_insn;
5231 rtx sub_cond_exec_reg;
5232 enum rtx_code code;
5233 enum rtx_code code_true;
5234 enum rtx_code code_false;
5235 enum reg_class cc_class;
5236 enum reg_class cr_class;
5237 int cc_first;
5238 int cc_last;
5239 reg_set_iterator rsi;
5241 /* Make sure we are only dealing with hard registers. Also honor the
5242 -mno-cond-exec switch, and -mno-nested-cond-exec switches if
5243 applicable. */
5244 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_COND_EXEC
5245 || (!TARGET_NESTED_CE && ce_info->pass > 1))
5246 goto fail;
5248 /* Figure out which registers we can allocate for our own purposes. Only
5249 consider registers that are not preserved across function calls and are
5250 not fixed. However, allow the ICC/ICR temporary registers to be allocated
5251 if we did not need to use them in reloading other registers. */
5252 memset (&tmp_reg->regs, 0, sizeof (tmp_reg->regs));
5253 COPY_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, call_used_reg_set);
5254 AND_COMPL_HARD_REG_SET (tmp_reg->regs, fixed_reg_set);
5255 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICC_TEMP);
5256 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, ICR_TEMP);
5258 /* If this is a nested IF, we need to discover whether the CC registers that
5259 are set/used inside of the block are used anywhere else. If not, we can
5260 change them to be the CC register that is paired with the CR register that
5261 controls the outermost IF block. */
5262 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5264 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5265 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5266 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5268 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (then_bb->global_live_at_start, j))
5269 continue;
5271 if (else_bb && REGNO_REG_SET_P (else_bb->global_live_at_start, j))
5272 continue;
5274 if (join_bb && REGNO_REG_SET_P (join_bb->global_live_at_start, j))
5275 continue;
5277 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j);
5281 for (j = 0; j < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; j++)
5282 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[j] = NULL_RTX;
5284 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
5285 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
5287 bb = (basic_block *) alloca ((2 + ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5288 * sizeof (basic_block));
5290 if (join_bb)
5292 int regno;
5294 /* Remove anything live at the beginning of the join block from being
5295 available for allocation. */
5296 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (join_bb->global_live_at_start, 0, regno, rsi)
5298 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5299 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5303 /* Add in all of the blocks in multiple &&/|| blocks to be scanned. */
5304 num_bb = 0;
5305 if (ce_info->num_multiple_test_blocks)
5307 basic_block multiple_test_bb = ce_info->last_test_bb;
5309 while (multiple_test_bb != test_bb)
5311 bb[num_bb++] = multiple_test_bb;
5312 multiple_test_bb = EDGE_PRED (multiple_test_bb, 0)->src;
5316 /* Add in the THEN and ELSE blocks to be scanned. */
5317 bb[num_bb++] = then_bb;
5318 if (else_bb)
5319 bb[num_bb++] = else_bb;
5321 sub_cond_exec_reg = NULL_RTX;
5322 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec = 0;
5324 /* Scan all of the blocks for registers that must not be allocated. */
5325 for (j = 0; j < num_bb; j++)
5327 rtx last_insn = BB_END (bb[j]);
5328 rtx insn = BB_HEAD (bb[j]);
5329 int regno;
5331 if (dump_file)
5332 fprintf (dump_file, "Scanning %s block %d, start %d, end %d\n",
5333 (bb[j] == else_bb) ? "else" : ((bb[j] == then_bb) ? "then" : "test"),
5334 (int) bb[j]->index,
5335 (int) INSN_UID (BB_HEAD (bb[j])),
5336 (int) INSN_UID (BB_END (bb[j])));
5338 /* Anything live at the beginning of the block is obviously unavailable
5339 for allocation. */
5340 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_REG_SET (bb[j]->global_live_at_start, 0, regno, rsi)
5342 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5343 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, regno);
5346 /* Loop through the insns in the block. */
5347 for (;;)
5349 /* Mark any new registers that are created as being unavailable for
5350 allocation. Also see if the CC register used in nested IFs can be
5351 reallocated. */
5352 if (INSN_P (insn))
5354 rtx pattern;
5355 rtx set;
5356 int skip_nested_if = FALSE;
5358 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5359 (void *)&tmp_reg->regs);
5361 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
5362 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5364 rtx reg = XEXP (COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern), 0);
5366 if (reg != sub_cond_exec_reg)
5368 sub_cond_exec_reg = reg;
5369 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec++;
5373 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5374 if (set)
5376 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5377 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5379 if (GET_CODE (dest) == REG)
5381 int regno = REGNO (dest);
5382 enum rtx_code src_code = GET_CODE (src);
5384 if (CC_P (regno) && src_code == COMPARE)
5385 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5387 else if (CR_P (regno)
5388 && (src_code == IF_THEN_ELSE
5389 || COMPARISON_P (src)))
5390 skip_nested_if = TRUE;
5394 if (! skip_nested_if)
5395 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_clear_registers_used,
5396 (void *)&frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite);
5399 if (insn == last_insn)
5400 break;
5402 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
5406 /* If this is a nested if, rewrite the CC registers that are available to
5407 include the ones that can be rewritten, to increase the chance of being
5408 able to allocate a paired CC/CR register combination. */
5409 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5411 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5412 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, j))
5413 SET_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5414 else
5415 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j);
5418 if (dump_file)
5420 int num_gprs = 0;
5421 fprintf (dump_file, "Available GPRs: ");
5423 for (j = GPR_FIRST; j <= GPR_LAST; j++)
5424 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5426 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5427 if (++num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2)
5428 break;
5431 fprintf (dump_file, "%s\nAvailable CRs: ",
5432 (num_gprs > GPR_TEMP_NUM+2) ? " ..." : "");
5434 for (j = CR_FIRST; j <= CR_LAST; j++)
5435 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5436 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5438 fputs ("\n", dump_file);
5440 if (ce_info->pass > 1)
5442 fprintf (dump_file, "Modifiable CCs: ");
5443 for (j = CC_FIRST; j <= CC_LAST; j++)
5444 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (tmp_reg->regs, j))
5445 fprintf (dump_file, " %d [%s]", j, reg_names[j]);
5447 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%d nested COND_EXEC statements\n",
5448 frv_ifcvt.num_nested_cond_exec);
5452 /* Allocate the appropriate temporary condition code register. Try to
5453 allocate the ICR/FCR register that corresponds to the ICC/FCC register so
5454 that conditional cmp's can be done. */
5455 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5457 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5458 cc_class = ICC_REGS;
5459 cc_first = ICC_FIRST;
5460 cc_last = ICC_LAST;
5462 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5464 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5465 cc_class = FCC_REGS;
5466 cc_first = FCC_FIRST;
5467 cc_last = FCC_LAST;
5469 else
5471 cc_first = cc_last = 0;
5472 cr_class = cc_class = NO_REGS;
5475 cc = XEXP (true_expr, 0);
5476 nested_cc = cr = NULL_RTX;
5477 if (cc_class != NO_REGS)
5479 /* For nested IFs and &&/||, see if we can find a CC and CR register pair
5480 so we can execute a csubcc/caddcc/cfcmps instruction. */
5481 int cc_regno;
5483 for (cc_regno = cc_first; cc_regno <= cc_last; cc_regno++)
5485 int cr_regno = cc_regno - CC_FIRST + CR_FIRST;
5487 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cc_regno)
5488 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, cr_regno))
5490 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cr_class ] = cr_regno;
5491 cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cr_class, CC_CCRmode, TRUE,
5492 TRUE);
5494 frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.next_reg[ (int)cc_class ] = cc_regno;
5495 nested_cc = frv_alloc_temp_reg (tmp_reg, cc_class, CCmode,
5496 TRUE, TRUE);
5497 break;
5502 if (! cr)
5504 if (dump_file)
5505 fprintf (dump_file, "Could not allocate a CR temporary register\n");
5507 goto fail;
5510 if (dump_file)
5511 fprintf (dump_file,
5512 "Will use %s for conditional execution, %s for nested comparisons\n",
5513 reg_names[ REGNO (cr)],
5514 (nested_cc) ? reg_names[ REGNO (nested_cc) ] : "<none>");
5516 /* Set the CCR bit. Note for integer tests, we reverse the condition so that
5517 in an IF-THEN-ELSE sequence, we are testing the TRUE case against the CCR
5518 bit being true. We don't do this for floating point, because of NaNs. */
5519 code = GET_CODE (true_expr);
5520 if (GET_MODE (cc) != CC_FPmode)
5522 code = reverse_condition (code);
5523 code_true = EQ;
5524 code_false = NE;
5526 else
5528 code_true = NE;
5529 code_false = EQ;
5532 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cr,
5533 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx));
5535 /* Record the check insn to be inserted later. */
5536 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (test_bb), TRUE);
5538 /* Update the tests. */
5539 frv_ifcvt.cr_reg = cr;
5540 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg = nested_cc;
5541 *p_true = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_true, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5542 *p_false = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code_false, CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5543 return;
5545 /* Fail, don't do this conditional execution. */
5546 fail:
5547 *p_true = NULL_RTX;
5548 *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5549 if (dump_file)
5550 fprintf (dump_file, "Disabling this conditional execution.\n");
5552 return;
5556 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5557 information CE_INFO, for the basic block BB, possibly updating the tests in
5558 TRUE_EXPR, and FALSE_EXPR for converting the && and || parts of if-then or
5559 if-then-else code to conditional instructions. Set either TRUE_EXPR or
5560 FALSE_EXPR to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted. */
5562 /* p_true and p_false are given expressions of the form:
5564 (and (eq:CC_CCR (reg:CC_CCR)
5565 (const_int 0))
5566 (eq:CC (reg:CC)
5567 (const_int 0))) */
5569 void
5570 frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
5571 basic_block bb,
5572 rtx *p_true,
5573 rtx *p_false)
5575 rtx old_true = XEXP (*p_true, 0);
5576 rtx old_false = XEXP (*p_false, 0);
5577 rtx true_expr = XEXP (*p_true, 1);
5578 rtx false_expr = XEXP (*p_false, 1);
5579 rtx test_expr;
5580 rtx old_test;
5581 rtx cr = XEXP (old_true, 0);
5582 rtx check_insn;
5583 rtx new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5584 rtx *p_new_cr = (rtx *)0;
5585 rtx if_else;
5586 rtx compare;
5587 rtx cc;
5588 enum reg_class cr_class;
5589 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (true_expr);
5590 rtx (*logical_func)(rtx, rtx, rtx);
5592 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5594 fprintf (stderr,
5595 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, before modification for %s\ntrue insn:\n",
5596 ce_info->and_and_p ? "&&" : "||");
5598 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5600 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5601 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5604 if (!TARGET_MULTI_CE)
5605 goto fail;
5607 if (GET_CODE (cr) != REG)
5608 goto fail;
5610 if (mode == CCmode || mode == CC_UNSmode || mode == CC_NZmode)
5612 cr_class = ICR_REGS;
5613 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_int_cr;
5615 else if (mode == CC_FPmode)
5617 cr_class = FCR_REGS;
5618 p_new_cr = &frv_ifcvt.extra_fp_cr;
5620 else
5621 goto fail;
5623 /* Allocate a temp CR, reusing a previously allocated temp CR if we have 3 or
5624 more &&/|| tests. */
5625 new_cr = *p_new_cr;
5626 if (! new_cr)
5628 new_cr = *p_new_cr = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, cr_class,
5629 CC_CCRmode, TRUE, TRUE);
5630 if (! new_cr)
5631 goto fail;
5634 if (ce_info->and_and_p)
5636 old_test = old_false;
5637 test_expr = true_expr;
5638 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_true) == EQ) ? gen_andcr : gen_andncr;
5639 *p_true = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5640 *p_false = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5642 else
5644 old_test = old_false;
5645 test_expr = false_expr;
5646 logical_func = (GET_CODE (old_false) == EQ) ? gen_orcr : gen_orncr;
5647 *p_true = gen_rtx_EQ (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5648 *p_false = gen_rtx_NE (CC_CCRmode, cr, const0_rtx);
5651 /* First add the andcr/andncr/orcr/orncr, which will be added after the
5652 conditional check instruction, due to frv_ifcvt_add_insn being a LIFO
5653 stack. */
5654 frv_ifcvt_add_insn ((*logical_func) (cr, cr, new_cr), BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5656 /* Now add the conditional check insn. */
5657 cc = XEXP (test_expr, 0);
5658 compare = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (test_expr), CC_CCRmode, cc, const0_rtx);
5659 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, old_test, compare, const0_rtx);
5661 check_insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_cr, if_else);
5663 /* Add the new check insn to the list of check insns that need to be
5664 inserted. */
5665 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (check_insn, BB_END (bb), TRUE);
5667 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5669 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, after modification\ntrue insn:\n",
5670 stderr);
5672 debug_rtx (*p_true);
5674 fputs ("\nfalse insn:\n", stderr);
5675 debug_rtx (*p_false);
5678 return;
5680 fail:
5681 *p_true = *p_false = NULL_RTX;
5683 /* If we allocated a CR register, release it. */
5684 if (new_cr)
5686 CLEAR_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg.regs, REGNO (new_cr));
5687 *p_new_cr = NULL_RTX;
5690 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
5691 fputs ("\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_multiple_tests, failed.\n", stderr);
5693 return;
5697 /* Return a register which will be loaded with a value if an IF block is
5698 converted to conditional execution. This is used to rewrite instructions
5699 that use constants to ones that just use registers. */
5701 static rtx
5702 frv_ifcvt_load_value (rtx value, rtx insn ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5704 int num_alloc = frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs;
5705 int i;
5706 rtx reg;
5708 /* We know gr0 == 0, so replace any errant uses. */
5709 if (value == const0_rtx)
5710 return gen_rtx_REG (SImode, GPR_FIRST);
5712 /* First search all registers currently loaded to see if we have an
5713 applicable constant. */
5714 if (CONSTANT_P (value)
5715 || (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO))
5717 for (i = 0; i < num_alloc; i++)
5719 if (rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]), value))
5720 return SET_DEST (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i]);
5724 /* Have we exhausted the number of registers available? */
5725 if (num_alloc >= GPR_TEMP_NUM)
5727 if (dump_file)
5728 fprintf (dump_file, "Too many temporary registers allocated\n");
5730 return NULL_RTX;
5733 /* Allocate the new register. */
5734 reg = frv_alloc_temp_reg (&frv_ifcvt.tmp_reg, GPR_REGS, SImode, TRUE, TRUE);
5735 if (! reg)
5737 if (dump_file)
5738 fputs ("Could not find a scratch register\n", dump_file);
5740 return NULL_RTX;
5743 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs++;
5744 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[num_alloc] = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, value);
5746 if (dump_file)
5748 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT)
5749 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold %ld\n",
5750 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)], (long)INTVAL (value));
5752 else if (GET_CODE (value) == REG && REGNO (value) == LR_REGNO)
5753 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold LR\n",
5754 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5756 else
5757 fprintf (dump_file, "Register %s will hold a saved value\n",
5758 reg_names[ REGNO (reg)]);
5761 return reg;
5765 /* Update a MEM used in conditional code that might contain an offset to put
5766 the offset into a scratch register, so that the conditional load/store
5767 operations can be used. This function returns the original pointer if the
5768 MEM is valid to use in conditional code, NULL if we can't load up the offset
5769 into a temporary register, or the new MEM if we were successful. */
5771 static rtx
5772 frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (rtx mem, enum machine_mode mode, rtx insn)
5774 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
5776 if (!frv_legitimate_address_p (mode, addr, reload_completed, TRUE, FALSE))
5778 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
5780 rtx addr_op0 = XEXP (addr, 0);
5781 rtx addr_op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5783 if (GET_CODE (addr_op0) == REG && CONSTANT_P (addr_op1))
5785 rtx reg = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr_op1, insn);
5786 if (!reg)
5787 return NULL_RTX;
5789 addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, addr_op0, reg);
5792 else
5793 return NULL_RTX;
5796 else if (CONSTANT_P (addr))
5797 addr = frv_ifcvt_load_value (addr, insn);
5799 else
5800 return NULL_RTX;
5802 if (addr == NULL_RTX)
5803 return NULL_RTX;
5805 else if (XEXP (mem, 0) != addr)
5806 return change_address (mem, mode, addr);
5809 return mem;
5813 /* Given a PATTERN, return a SET expression if this PATTERN has only a single
5814 SET, possibly conditionally executed. It may also have CLOBBERs, USEs. */
5816 static rtx
5817 single_set_pattern (rtx pattern)
5819 rtx set;
5820 int i;
5822 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC)
5823 pattern = COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern);
5825 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
5826 return pattern;
5828 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL)
5830 for (i = 0, set = 0; i < XVECLEN (pattern, 0); i++)
5832 rtx sub = XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i);
5834 switch (GET_CODE (sub))
5836 case USE:
5837 case CLOBBER:
5838 break;
5840 case SET:
5841 if (set)
5842 return 0;
5843 else
5844 set = sub;
5845 break;
5847 default:
5848 return 0;
5851 return set;
5854 return 0;
5858 /* A C expression to modify the code described by the conditional if
5859 information CE_INFO with the new PATTERN in INSN. If PATTERN is a null
5860 pointer after the IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN macro executes, it is assumed that that
5861 insn cannot be converted to be executed conditionally. */
5864 frv_ifcvt_modify_insn (ce_if_block_t *ce_info,
5865 rtx pattern,
5866 rtx insn)
5868 rtx orig_ce_pattern = pattern;
5869 rtx set;
5870 rtx op0;
5871 rtx op1;
5872 rtx test;
5874 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pattern) == COND_EXEC);
5876 test = COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern);
5877 if (GET_CODE (test) == AND)
5879 rtx cr = frv_ifcvt.cr_reg;
5880 rtx test_reg;
5882 op0 = XEXP (test, 0);
5883 if (! rtx_equal_p (cr, XEXP (op0, 0)))
5884 goto fail;
5886 op1 = XEXP (test, 1);
5887 test_reg = XEXP (op1, 0);
5888 if (GET_CODE (test_reg) != REG)
5889 goto fail;
5891 /* Is this the first nested if block in this sequence? If so, generate
5892 an andcr or andncr. */
5893 if (! frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr)
5895 rtx and_op;
5897 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = test_reg;
5898 if (GET_CODE (op0) == NE)
5899 and_op = gen_andcr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5900 else
5901 and_op = gen_andncr (test_reg, cr, test_reg);
5903 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (and_op, insn, TRUE);
5906 /* If this isn't the first statement in the nested if sequence, see if we
5907 are dealing with the same register. */
5908 else if (! rtx_equal_p (test_reg, frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr))
5909 goto fail;
5911 COND_EXEC_TEST (pattern) = test = op1;
5914 /* If this isn't a nested if, reset state variables. */
5915 else
5917 frv_ifcvt.last_nested_if_cr = NULL_RTX;
5920 set = single_set_pattern (pattern);
5921 if (set)
5923 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
5924 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
5925 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
5927 /* Check for normal binary operators. */
5928 if (mode == SImode && ARITHMETIC_P (src))
5930 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5931 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5933 if (integer_register_operand (op0, SImode) && CONSTANT_P (op1))
5935 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
5936 if (op1)
5937 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
5938 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
5939 GET_MODE (src),
5940 op0, op1));
5941 else
5942 goto fail;
5946 /* For multiply by a constant, we need to handle the sign extending
5947 correctly. Add a USE of the value after the multiply to prevent flow
5948 from cratering because only one register out of the two were used. */
5949 else if (mode == DImode && GET_CODE (src) == MULT)
5951 op0 = XEXP (src, 0);
5952 op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5953 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SIGN_EXTEND && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
5955 op1 = frv_ifcvt_load_value (op1, insn);
5956 if (op1)
5958 op1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (DImode, op1);
5959 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
5960 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest,
5961 gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, op0, op1));
5963 else
5964 goto fail;
5967 frv_ifcvt_add_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, dest), insn, FALSE);
5970 /* If we are just loading a constant created for a nested conditional
5971 execution statement, just load the constant without any conditional
5972 execution, since we know that the constant will not interfere with any
5973 other registers. */
5974 else if (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap
5975 && bitmap_bit_p (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap,
5976 INSN_UID (insn))
5977 && REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
5978 /* We must not unconditionally set a scratch reg chosen
5979 for a nested if-converted block if its incoming
5980 value from the TEST block (or the result of the THEN
5981 branch) could/should propagate to the JOIN block.
5982 It suffices to test whether the register is live at
5983 the JOIN point: if it's live there, we can infer
5984 that we set it in the former JOIN block of the
5985 nested if-converted block (otherwise it wouldn't
5986 have been available as a scratch register), and it
5987 is either propagated through or set in the other
5988 conditional block. It's probably not worth trying
5989 to catch the latter case, and it could actually
5990 limit scheduling of the combined block quite
5991 severely. */
5992 && ce_info->join_bb
5993 && ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P
5994 (ce_info->join_bb->global_live_at_start,
5995 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))
5996 /* Similarly, we must not unconditionally set a reg
5997 used as scratch in the THEN branch if the same reg
5998 is live in the ELSE branch. */
5999 && (! ce_info->else_bb
6000 || BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn) == ce_info->else_bb
6001 || ! (REGNO_REG_SET_P
6002 (ce_info->else_bb->global_live_at_start,
6003 REGNO (SET_DEST (set))))))
6004 pattern = set;
6006 else if (mode == QImode || mode == HImode || mode == SImode
6007 || mode == SFmode)
6009 int changed_p = FALSE;
6011 /* Check for just loading up a constant */
6012 if (CONSTANT_P (src) && integer_register_operand (dest, mode))
6014 src = frv_ifcvt_load_value (src, insn);
6015 if (!src)
6016 goto fail;
6018 changed_p = TRUE;
6021 /* See if we need to fix up stores */
6022 if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
6024 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (dest, mode, insn);
6026 if (!new_mem)
6027 goto fail;
6029 else if (new_mem != dest)
6031 changed_p = TRUE;
6032 dest = new_mem;
6036 /* See if we need to fix up loads */
6037 if (GET_CODE (src) == MEM)
6039 rtx new_mem = frv_ifcvt_rewrite_mem (src, mode, insn);
6041 if (!new_mem)
6042 goto fail;
6044 else if (new_mem != src)
6046 changed_p = TRUE;
6047 src = new_mem;
6051 /* If either src or destination changed, redo SET. */
6052 if (changed_p)
6053 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern) = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src);
6056 /* Rewrite a nested set cccr in terms of IF_THEN_ELSE. Also deal with
6057 rewriting the CC register to be the same as the paired CC/CR register
6058 for nested ifs. */
6059 else if (mode == CC_CCRmode && COMPARISON_P (src))
6061 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (src, 0));
6062 rtx if_else;
6064 if (ce_info->pass > 1
6065 && regno != (int)REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6066 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite, regno))
6068 src = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (src),
6069 CC_CCRmode,
6070 frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg,
6071 XEXP (src, 1));
6074 if_else = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (CC_CCRmode, test, src, const0_rtx);
6075 pattern = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, if_else);
6078 /* Remap a nested compare instruction to use the paired CC/CR reg. */
6079 else if (ce_info->pass > 1
6080 && GET_CODE (dest) == REG
6081 && CC_P (REGNO (dest))
6082 && REGNO (dest) != REGNO (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg)
6083 && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_ok_rewrite,
6084 REGNO (dest))
6085 && GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE)
6087 PUT_MODE (frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, GET_MODE (dest));
6088 COND_EXEC_CODE (pattern)
6089 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, frv_ifcvt.nested_cc_reg, copy_rtx (src));
6093 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6095 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6097 PATTERN (insn) = pattern;
6098 fprintf (stderr,
6099 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn after modification:\n",
6100 ce_info->pass);
6102 debug_rtx (insn);
6103 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6106 return pattern;
6108 fail:
6109 if (TARGET_DEBUG_COND_EXEC)
6111 rtx orig_pattern = PATTERN (insn);
6113 PATTERN (insn) = orig_ce_pattern;
6114 fprintf (stderr,
6115 "\n:::::::::: frv_ifcvt_modify_insn: pass = %d, insn could not be modified:\n",
6116 ce_info->pass);
6118 debug_rtx (insn);
6119 PATTERN (insn) = orig_pattern;
6122 return NULL_RTX;
6126 /* A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
6127 converting code to conditional execution in the code described by the
6128 conditional if information CE_INFO. */
6130 void
6131 frv_ifcvt_modify_final (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6133 rtx existing_insn;
6134 rtx check_insn;
6135 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6136 int i;
6138 /* Loop inserting the check insns. The last check insn is the first test,
6139 and is the appropriate place to insert constants. */
6140 gcc_assert (p);
6144 rtx check_and_insert_insns = XEXP (p, 0);
6145 rtx old_p = p;
6147 check_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 0);
6148 existing_insn = XEXP (check_and_insert_insns, 1);
6149 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6151 /* The jump bit is used to say that the new insn is to be inserted BEFORE
6152 the existing insn, otherwise it is to be inserted AFTER. */
6153 if (check_and_insert_insns->jump)
6155 emit_insn_before (check_insn, existing_insn);
6156 check_and_insert_insns->jump = 0;
6158 else
6159 emit_insn_after (check_insn, existing_insn);
6161 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_insert_insns);
6162 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6164 while (p != NULL_RTX);
6166 /* Load up any constants needed into temp gprs */
6167 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6169 rtx insn = emit_insn_before (frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i], existing_insn);
6170 if (! frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap)
6171 frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
6172 bitmap_set_bit (frv_ifcvt.scratch_insns_bitmap, INSN_UID (insn));
6173 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6176 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6177 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6181 /* A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in converting
6182 code to conditional execution in the code described by the conditional if
6183 information CE_INFO. */
6185 void
6186 frv_ifcvt_modify_cancel (ce_if_block_t *ce_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6188 int i;
6189 rtx p = frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list;
6191 /* Loop freeing up the EXPR_LIST's allocated. */
6192 while (p != NULL_RTX)
6194 rtx check_and_jump = XEXP (p, 0);
6195 rtx old_p = p;
6197 p = XEXP (p, 1);
6198 free_EXPR_LIST_node (check_and_jump);
6199 free_EXPR_LIST_node (old_p);
6202 /* Release any temporary gprs allocated. */
6203 for (i = 0; i < frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs; i++)
6204 frv_ifcvt.scratch_regs[i] = NULL_RTX;
6206 frv_ifcvt.added_insns_list = NULL_RTX;
6207 frv_ifcvt.cur_scratch_regs = 0;
6208 return;
6211 /* A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
6212 The template is:
6214 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6215 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6216 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6217 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6218 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6221 frv_trampoline_size (void)
6223 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6224 /* Allocate room for the function descriptor and the lddi
6225 instruction. */
6226 return 8 + 6 * 4;
6227 return 5 /* instructions */ * 4 /* instruction size. */;
6231 /* A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline. ADDR is an
6232 RTX for the address of the trampoline; FNADDR is an RTX for the address of
6233 the nested function; STATIC_CHAIN is an RTX for the static chain value that
6234 should be passed to the function when it is called.
6236 The template is:
6238 setlo #0, <jmp_reg>
6239 setlo #0, <static_chain>
6240 sethi #0, <jmp_reg>
6241 sethi #0, <static_chain>
6242 jmpl @(gr0,<jmp_reg>) */
6244 void
6245 frv_initialize_trampoline (rtx addr, rtx fnaddr, rtx static_chain)
6247 rtx sc_reg = force_reg (Pmode, static_chain);
6249 emit_library_call (gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (SImode, "__trampoline_setup"),
6250 FALSE, VOIDmode, 4,
6251 addr, Pmode,
6252 GEN_INT (frv_trampoline_size ()), SImode,
6253 fnaddr, Pmode,
6254 sc_reg, Pmode);
6258 /* Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or from
6259 memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the `MQ'
6260 register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or from general
6261 registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all registers to and
6262 from memory, but require a scratch register for stores to some memory
6263 locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT, and those with
6264 certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling PIC). In some cases,
6265 both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
6267 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
6268 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
6269 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying X to a register
6270 CLASS in MODE requires an intermediate register, you should define
6271 `SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' to return the largest register class all of
6272 whose registers can be used as intermediate registers or scratch registers.
6274 If copying a register CLASS in MODE to X requires an intermediate or scratch
6275 register, `SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS' should be defined to return the
6276 largest register class required. If the requirements for input and output
6277 reloads are the same, the macro `SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS' should be used
6278 instead of defining both macros identically.
6280 The values returned by these macros are often `GENERAL_REGS'. Return
6281 `NO_REGS' if no spare register is needed; i.e., if X can be directly copied
6282 to or from a register of CLASS in MODE without requiring a scratch register.
6283 Do not define this macro if it would always return `NO_REGS'.
6285 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an intermediate
6286 register), you should define patterns for `reload_inM' or `reload_outM', as
6287 required.. These patterns, which will normally be implemented with a
6288 `define_expand', should be similar to the `movM' patterns, except that
6289 operand 2 is the scratch register.
6291 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that contain
6292 a single register class. If the original reload register (whose class is
6293 CLASS) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the value returned by
6294 these macros is used for the class of the scratch register. Otherwise, two
6295 additional reload registers are required. Their classes are obtained from
6296 the constraints in the insn pattern.
6298 X might be a pseudo-register or a `subreg' of a pseudo-register, which could
6299 either be in a hard register or in memory. Use `true_regnum' to find out;
6300 it will return -1 if the pseudo is in memory and the hard register number if
6301 it is in a register.
6303 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
6304 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
6305 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
6306 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform the
6307 copy and the `movM' pattern should use memory as an intermediate storage.
6308 This case often occurs between floating-point and general registers. */
6310 enum reg_class
6311 frv_secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class class,
6312 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6313 rtx x,
6314 int in_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6316 enum reg_class ret;
6318 switch (class)
6320 default:
6321 ret = NO_REGS;
6322 break;
6324 /* Accumulators/Accumulator guard registers need to go through floating
6325 point registers. */
6326 case QUAD_REGS:
6327 case EVEN_REGS:
6328 case GPR_REGS:
6329 ret = NO_REGS;
6330 if (x && GET_CODE (x) == REG)
6332 int regno = REGNO (x);
6334 if (ACC_P (regno) || ACCG_P (regno))
6335 ret = FPR_REGS;
6337 break;
6339 /* Nonzero constants should be loaded into an FPR through a GPR. */
6340 case QUAD_FPR_REGS:
6341 case FEVEN_REGS:
6342 case FPR_REGS:
6343 if (x && CONSTANT_P (x) && !ZERO_P (x))
6344 ret = GPR_REGS;
6345 else
6346 ret = NO_REGS;
6347 break;
6349 /* All of these types need gpr registers. */
6350 case ICC_REGS:
6351 case FCC_REGS:
6352 case CC_REGS:
6353 case ICR_REGS:
6354 case FCR_REGS:
6355 case CR_REGS:
6356 case LCR_REG:
6357 case LR_REG:
6358 ret = GPR_REGS;
6359 break;
6361 /* The accumulators need fpr registers */
6362 case ACC_REGS:
6363 case EVEN_ACC_REGS:
6364 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6365 case ACCG_REGS:
6366 ret = FPR_REGS;
6367 break;
6370 return ret;
6374 /* A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned to
6375 registers of class CLASS would likely be spilled because registers of CLASS
6376 are needed for spill registers.
6378 The default value of this macro returns 1 if CLASS has exactly one register
6379 and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be used. Only
6380 define this macro to some other expression if pseudo allocated by
6381 `local-alloc.c' end up in memory because their hard registers were needed
6382 for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero for those classes, those
6383 pseudos will only be allocated by `global.c', which knows how to reallocate
6384 the pseudo to another register. If there would not be another register
6385 available for reallocation, you should not change the definition of this
6386 macro since the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down
6387 register allocation. */
6390 frv_class_likely_spilled_p (enum reg_class class)
6392 switch (class)
6394 default:
6395 break;
6397 case GR8_REGS:
6398 case GR9_REGS:
6399 case GR89_REGS:
6400 case FDPIC_FPTR_REGS:
6401 case FDPIC_REGS:
6402 case ICC_REGS:
6403 case FCC_REGS:
6404 case CC_REGS:
6405 case ICR_REGS:
6406 case FCR_REGS:
6407 case CR_REGS:
6408 case LCR_REG:
6409 case LR_REG:
6410 case SPR_REGS:
6411 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6412 case EVEN_ACC_REGS:
6413 case ACC_REGS:
6414 case ACCG_REGS:
6415 return TRUE;
6418 return FALSE;
6422 /* An expression for the alignment of a structure field FIELD if the
6423 alignment computed in the usual way is COMPUTED. GCC uses this
6424 value instead of the value in `BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT' or
6425 `BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT', if defined, for structure fields only. */
6427 /* The definition type of the bit field data is either char, short, long or
6428 long long. The maximum bit size is the number of bits of its own type.
6430 The bit field data is assigned to a storage unit that has an adequate size
6431 for bit field data retention and is located at the smallest address.
6433 Consecutive bit field data are packed at consecutive bits having the same
6434 storage unit, with regard to the type, beginning with the MSB and continuing
6435 toward the LSB.
6437 If a field to be assigned lies over a bit field type boundary, its
6438 assignment is completed by aligning it with a boundary suitable for the
6439 type.
6441 When a bit field having a bit length of 0 is declared, it is forcibly
6442 assigned to the next storage unit.
6444 e.g)
6445 struct {
6446 int a:2;
6447 int b:6;
6448 char c:4;
6449 int d:10;
6450 int :0;
6451 int f:2;
6452 } x;
6454 +0 +1 +2 +3
6455 &x 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6456 MLM----L
6458 &x+4 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6459 M--L
6461 &x+8 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6462 M----------L
6464 &x+12 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000
6470 frv_adjust_field_align (tree field, int computed)
6472 /* Make sure that the bitfield is not wider than the type. */
6473 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
6474 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (field))
6476 tree parent = DECL_CONTEXT (field);
6477 tree prev = NULL_TREE;
6478 tree cur;
6480 for (cur = TYPE_FIELDS (parent); cur && cur != field; cur = TREE_CHAIN (cur))
6482 if (TREE_CODE (cur) != FIELD_DECL)
6483 continue;
6485 prev = cur;
6488 gcc_assert (cur);
6490 /* If this isn't a :0 field and if the previous element is a bitfield
6491 also, see if the type is different, if so, we will need to align the
6492 bit-field to the next boundary. */
6493 if (prev
6494 && ! DECL_PACKED (field)
6495 && ! integer_zerop (DECL_SIZE (field))
6496 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field) != DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (prev))
6498 int prev_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (prev));
6499 int cur_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (field));
6500 computed = (prev_align > cur_align) ? prev_align : cur_align;
6504 return computed;
6508 /* A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value of mode
6509 MODE in hard register number REGNO (or in several registers starting with
6510 that one). For a machine where all registers are equivalent, a suitable
6511 definition is
6513 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
6515 It is not necessary for this macro to check for the numbers of fixed
6516 registers, because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always
6517 occupied.
6519 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd register
6520 pairs. The way to implement that is to define this macro to reject odd
6521 register numbers for such modes.
6523 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
6524 `movMODE' instruction pattern support moves between the register and any
6525 other hard register for which the mode is OK; and that moving a value into
6526 the register and back out not alter it.
6528 Since the same instruction used to move `SImode' will work for all narrower
6529 integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'
6530 to distinguish between these modes, provided you define patterns `movhi',
6531 etc., to take advantage of this. This is useful because of the interaction
6532 between `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' and `MODES_TIEABLE_P'; it is very desirable for
6533 all integer modes to be tieable.
6535 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic. Often
6536 people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only in floating
6537 point registers. This is not true. Any registers that can hold integers
6538 can safely *hold* a floating point machine mode, whether or not floating
6539 arithmetic can be done on it in those registers. Integer move instructions
6540 can be used to move the values.
6542 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine modes
6543 may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating registers
6544 normalize any value stored in them, because storing a non-floating value
6545 there would garble it. In this case, `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK' should reject
6546 fixed-point machine modes in floating registers. But if the floating
6547 registers do not automatically normalize, if you can store any bit pattern
6548 in one and retrieve it unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may
6549 go in a floating register, so you can define this macro to say so.
6551 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that they
6552 are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic instructions.
6553 However, this is of no concern to `HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK'. You handle it by
6554 writing the proper constraints for those instructions.
6556 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access, so
6557 that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a register
6558 if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the floating
6559 registers are not in class `GENERAL_REGS', they will not be used unless some
6560 pattern's constraint asks for one. */
6563 frv_hard_regno_mode_ok (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6565 int base;
6566 int mask;
6568 switch (mode)
6570 case CCmode:
6571 case CC_UNSmode:
6572 case CC_NZmode:
6573 return ICC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6575 case CC_CCRmode:
6576 return CR_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6578 case CC_FPmode:
6579 return FCC_P (regno) || GPR_P (regno);
6581 default:
6582 break;
6585 /* Set BASE to the first register in REGNO's class. Set MASK to the
6586 bits that must be clear in (REGNO - BASE) for the register to be
6587 well-aligned. */
6588 if (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) || FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
6590 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6592 /* ACCGs store one byte. Two-byte quantities must start in
6593 even-numbered registers, four-byte ones in registers whose
6594 numbers are divisible by four, and so on. */
6595 base = ACCG_FIRST;
6596 mask = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1;
6598 else
6600 /* The other registers store one word. */
6601 if (GPR_P (regno) || regno == AP_FIRST)
6602 base = GPR_FIRST;
6604 else if (FPR_P (regno))
6605 base = FPR_FIRST;
6607 else if (ACC_P (regno))
6608 base = ACC_FIRST;
6610 else if (SPR_P (regno))
6611 return mode == SImode;
6613 /* Fill in the table. */
6614 else
6615 return 0;
6617 /* Anything smaller than an SI is OK in any word-sized register. */
6618 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4)
6619 return 1;
6621 mask = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4) - 1;
6623 return (((regno - base) & mask) == 0);
6626 return 0;
6630 /* A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting at
6631 register number REGNO, required to hold a value of mode MODE.
6633 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable definition
6634 of this macro is
6636 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
6637 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
6638 / UNITS_PER_WORD)) */
6640 /* On the FRV, make the CC_FP mode take 3 words in the integer registers, so
6641 that we can build the appropriate instructions to properly reload the
6642 values. Also, make the byte-sized accumulator guards use one guard
6643 for each byte. */
6646 frv_hard_regno_nregs (int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
6648 if (ACCG_P (regno))
6649 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6650 else
6651 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6655 /* A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers of
6656 class CLASS needed to hold a value of mode MODE.
6658 This is closely related to the macro `HARD_REGNO_NREGS'. In fact, the value
6659 of the macro `CLASS_MAX_NREGS (CLASS, MODE)' should be the maximum value of
6660 `HARD_REGNO_NREGS (REGNO, MODE)' for all REGNO values in the class CLASS.
6662 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values in
6663 the reload pass.
6665 This declaration is required. */
6668 frv_class_max_nregs (enum reg_class class, enum machine_mode mode)
6670 if (class == ACCG_REGS)
6671 /* An N-byte value requires N accumulator guards. */
6672 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
6673 else
6674 return (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6678 /* A C expression that is nonzero if X is a legitimate constant for an
6679 immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that X satisfies
6680 `CONSTANT_P', so you need not check this. In fact, `1' is a suitable
6681 definition for this macro on machines where anything `CONSTANT_P' is valid. */
6684 frv_legitimate_constant_p (rtx x)
6686 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
6688 /* frv_cannot_force_const_mem always returns true for FDPIC. This
6689 means that the move expanders will be expected to deal with most
6690 kinds of constant, regardless of what we return here.
6692 However, among its other duties, LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P decides whether
6693 a constant can be entered into reg_equiv_constant[]. If we return true,
6694 reload can create new instances of the constant whenever it likes.
6696 The idea is therefore to accept as many constants as possible (to give
6697 reload more freedom) while rejecting constants that can only be created
6698 at certain times. In particular, anything with a symbolic component will
6699 require use of the pseudo FDPIC register, which is only available before
6700 reload. */
6701 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
6702 return LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (x);
6704 /* All of the integer constants are ok. */
6705 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_DOUBLE)
6706 return TRUE;
6708 /* double integer constants are ok. */
6709 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == DImode)
6710 return TRUE;
6712 /* 0 is always ok. */
6713 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
6714 return TRUE;
6716 /* If floating point is just emulated, allow any constant, since it will be
6717 constructed in the GPRs. */
6718 if (!TARGET_HAS_FPRS)
6719 return TRUE;
6721 if (mode == DFmode && !TARGET_DOUBLE)
6722 return TRUE;
6724 /* Otherwise store the constant away and do a load. */
6725 return FALSE;
6728 /* Implement SELECT_CC_MODE. Choose CC_FP for floating-point comparisons,
6729 CC_NZ for comparisons against zero in which a single Z or N flag test
6730 is enough, CC_UNS for other unsigned comparisons, and CC for other
6731 signed comparisons. */
6733 enum machine_mode
6734 frv_select_cc_mode (enum rtx_code code, rtx x, rtx y)
6736 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
6737 return CC_FPmode;
6739 switch (code)
6741 case EQ:
6742 case NE:
6743 case LT:
6744 case GE:
6745 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CCmode;
6747 case GTU:
6748 case GEU:
6749 case LTU:
6750 case LEU:
6751 return y == const0_rtx ? CC_NZmode : CC_UNSmode;
6753 default:
6754 return CCmode;
6758 /* A C expression for the cost of moving data from a register in class FROM to
6759 one in class TO. The classes are expressed using the enumeration values
6760 such as `GENERAL_REGS'. A value of 4 is the default; other values are
6761 interpreted relative to that.
6763 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when FROM is the same as TO;
6764 on some machines it is expensive to move between registers if they are not
6765 general registers.
6767 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single `set' between two hard
6768 registers, and if `REGISTER_MOVE_COST' applied to their classes returns a
6769 value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the constraints of the insn
6770 are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will allow reload to verify that
6771 the constraints are met. You should do this if the `movM' pattern's
6772 constraints do not allow such copying. */
6774 #define HIGH_COST 40
6775 #define MEDIUM_COST 3
6776 #define LOW_COST 1
6779 frv_register_move_cost (enum reg_class from, enum reg_class to)
6781 switch (from)
6783 default:
6784 break;
6786 case QUAD_REGS:
6787 case EVEN_REGS:
6788 case GPR_REGS:
6789 switch (to)
6791 default:
6792 break;
6794 case QUAD_REGS:
6795 case EVEN_REGS:
6796 case GPR_REGS:
6797 return LOW_COST;
6799 case FEVEN_REGS:
6800 case FPR_REGS:
6801 return LOW_COST;
6803 case LCR_REG:
6804 case LR_REG:
6805 case SPR_REGS:
6806 return LOW_COST;
6809 case FEVEN_REGS:
6810 case FPR_REGS:
6811 switch (to)
6813 default:
6814 break;
6816 case QUAD_REGS:
6817 case EVEN_REGS:
6818 case GPR_REGS:
6819 case ACC_REGS:
6820 case EVEN_ACC_REGS:
6821 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6822 case ACCG_REGS:
6823 return MEDIUM_COST;
6825 case FEVEN_REGS:
6826 case FPR_REGS:
6827 return LOW_COST;
6830 case LCR_REG:
6831 case LR_REG:
6832 case SPR_REGS:
6833 switch (to)
6835 default:
6836 break;
6838 case QUAD_REGS:
6839 case EVEN_REGS:
6840 case GPR_REGS:
6841 return MEDIUM_COST;
6844 case ACC_REGS:
6845 case EVEN_ACC_REGS:
6846 case QUAD_ACC_REGS:
6847 case ACCG_REGS:
6848 switch (to)
6850 default:
6851 break;
6853 case FEVEN_REGS:
6854 case FPR_REGS:
6855 return MEDIUM_COST;
6860 return HIGH_COST;
6863 /* Implementation of TARGET_ASM_INTEGER. In the FRV case we need to
6864 use ".picptr" to generate safe relocations for PIC code. We also
6865 need a fixup entry for aligned (non-debugging) code. */
6867 static bool
6868 frv_assemble_integer (rtx value, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
6870 if ((flag_pic || TARGET_FDPIC) && size == UNITS_PER_WORD)
6872 if (GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6873 || GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6874 || GET_CODE (value) == LABEL_REF)
6876 if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF
6877 && SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (value))
6879 fputs ("\t.picptr\tfuncdesc(", asm_out_file);
6880 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, value);
6881 fputs (")\n", asm_out_file);
6882 return true;
6884 else if (TARGET_FDPIC && GET_CODE (value) == CONST
6885 && frv_function_symbol_referenced_p (value))
6886 return false;
6887 if (aligned_p && !TARGET_FDPIC)
6889 static int label_num = 0;
6890 char buf[256];
6891 const char *p;
6893 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, "LCP", label_num++);
6894 p = (* targetm.strip_name_encoding) (buf);
6896 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s:\n", p);
6897 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s\n", FIXUP_SECTION_ASM_OP);
6898 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.picptr\t%s\n", p);
6899 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.previous\n");
6901 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", value);
6902 return true;
6904 if (!aligned_p)
6906 /* We've set the unaligned SI op to NULL, so we always have to
6907 handle the unaligned case here. */
6908 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.4byte\t", value);
6909 return true;
6912 return default_assemble_integer (value, size, aligned_p);
6915 /* Function to set up the backend function structure. */
6917 static struct machine_function *
6918 frv_init_machine_status (void)
6920 return ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct machine_function));
6923 /* Implement TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE. */
6926 frv_issue_rate (void)
6928 if (!TARGET_PACK)
6929 return 1;
6931 switch (frv_cpu_type)
6933 default:
6934 case FRV_CPU_FR300:
6935 case FRV_CPU_SIMPLE:
6936 return 1;
6938 case FRV_CPU_FR400:
6939 case FRV_CPU_FR405:
6940 case FRV_CPU_FR450:
6941 return 2;
6943 case FRV_CPU_GENERIC:
6944 case FRV_CPU_FR500:
6945 case FRV_CPU_TOMCAT:
6946 return 4;
6948 case FRV_CPU_FR550:
6949 return 8;
6953 /* A for_each_rtx callback. If X refers to an accumulator, return
6954 ACC_GROUP_ODD if the bit 2 of the register number is set and
6955 ACC_GROUP_EVEN if it is clear. Return 0 (ACC_GROUP_NONE)
6956 otherwise. */
6958 static int
6959 frv_acc_group_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6961 if (REG_P (*x))
6963 if (ACC_P (REGNO (*x)))
6964 return (REGNO (*x) - ACC_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
6965 if (ACCG_P (REGNO (*x)))
6966 return (REGNO (*x) - ACCG_FIRST) & 4 ? ACC_GROUP_ODD : ACC_GROUP_EVEN;
6968 return 0;
6971 /* Return the value of INSN's acc_group attribute. */
6974 frv_acc_group (rtx insn)
6976 /* This distinction only applies to the FR550 packing constraints. */
6977 if (frv_cpu_type != FRV_CPU_FR550)
6978 return ACC_GROUP_NONE;
6979 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), frv_acc_group_1, 0);
6982 /* Return the index of the DFA unit in FRV_UNIT_NAMES[] that instruction
6983 INSN will try to claim first. Since this value depends only on the
6984 type attribute, we can cache the results in FRV_TYPE_TO_UNIT[]. */
6986 static unsigned int
6987 frv_insn_unit (rtx insn)
6989 enum attr_type type;
6991 type = get_attr_type (insn);
6992 if (frv_type_to_unit[type] == ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes))
6994 /* We haven't seen this type of instruction before. */
6995 state_t state;
6996 unsigned int unit;
6998 /* Issue the instruction on its own to see which unit it prefers. */
6999 state = alloca (state_size ());
7000 state_reset (state);
7001 state_transition (state, insn);
7003 /* Find out which unit was taken. */
7004 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes); unit++)
7005 if (cpu_unit_reservation_p (state, frv_unit_codes[unit]))
7006 break;
7008 gcc_assert (unit != ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes));
7010 frv_type_to_unit[type] = unit;
7012 return frv_type_to_unit[type];
7015 /* Return true if INSN issues to a branch unit. */
7017 static bool
7018 frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (rtx insn)
7020 return frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)] == GROUP_B;
7023 /* The current state of the packing pass, implemented by frv_pack_insns. */
7024 static struct {
7025 /* The state of the pipeline DFA. */
7026 state_t dfa_state;
7028 /* Which hardware registers are set within the current packet,
7029 and the conditions under which they are set. */
7030 regstate_t regstate[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
7032 /* The memory locations that have been modified so far in this
7033 packet. MEM is the memref and COND is the regstate_t condition
7034 under which it is set. */
7035 struct {
7036 rtx mem;
7037 regstate_t cond;
7038 } mems[2];
7040 /* The number of valid entries in MEMS. The value is larger than
7041 ARRAY_SIZE (mems) if there were too many mems to record. */
7042 unsigned int num_mems;
7044 /* The maximum number of instructions that can be packed together. */
7045 unsigned int issue_rate;
7047 /* The instructions in the packet, partitioned into groups. */
7048 struct frv_packet_group {
7049 /* How many instructions in the packet belong to this group. */
7050 unsigned int num_insns;
7052 /* A list of the instructions that belong to this group, in the order
7053 they appear in the rtl stream. */
7054 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7056 /* The contents of INSNS after they have been sorted into the correct
7057 assembly-language order. Element X issues to unit X. The list may
7058 contain extra nops. */
7059 rtx sorted[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7061 /* The member of frv_nops[] to use in sorted[]. */
7062 rtx nop;
7063 } groups[NUM_GROUPS];
7065 /* The instructions that make up the current packet. */
7066 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_codes)];
7067 unsigned int num_insns;
7068 } frv_packet;
7070 /* Return the regstate_t flags for the given COND_EXEC condition.
7071 Abort if the condition isn't in the right form. */
7073 static int
7074 frv_cond_flags (rtx cond)
7076 gcc_assert ((GET_CODE (cond) == EQ || GET_CODE (cond) == NE)
7077 && GET_CODE (XEXP (cond, 0)) == REG
7078 && CR_P (REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)))
7079 && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx);
7080 return ((REGNO (XEXP (cond, 0)) - CR_FIRST)
7081 | (GET_CODE (cond) == NE
7082 ? REGSTATE_IF_TRUE
7083 : REGSTATE_IF_FALSE));
7087 /* Return true if something accessed under condition COND2 can
7088 conflict with something written under condition COND1. */
7090 static bool
7091 frv_regstate_conflict_p (regstate_t cond1, regstate_t cond2)
7093 /* If either reference was unconditional, we have a conflict. */
7094 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0
7095 || (cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) == 0)
7096 return true;
7098 /* The references might conflict if they were controlled by
7099 different CRs. */
7100 if ((cond1 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK) != (cond2 & REGSTATE_CC_MASK))
7101 return true;
7103 /* They definitely conflict if they are controlled by the
7104 same condition. */
7105 if ((cond1 & cond2 & REGSTATE_IF_EITHER) != 0)
7106 return true;
7108 return false;
7112 /* A for_each_rtx callback. Return 1 if *X depends on an instruction in
7113 the current packet. DATA points to a regstate_t that describes the
7114 condition under which *X might be set or used. */
7116 static int
7117 frv_registers_conflict_p_1 (rtx *x, void *data)
7119 unsigned int regno, i;
7120 regstate_t cond;
7122 cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7124 if (GET_CODE (*x) == REG)
7125 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, *x)
7126 if ((frv_packet.regstate[regno] & REGSTATE_MODIFIED) != 0)
7127 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.regstate[regno], cond))
7128 return 1;
7130 if (GET_CODE (*x) == MEM)
7132 /* If we ran out of memory slots, assume a conflict. */
7133 if (frv_packet.num_mems > ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7134 return 1;
7136 /* Check for output or true dependencies with earlier MEMs. */
7137 for (i = 0; i < frv_packet.num_mems; i++)
7138 if (frv_regstate_conflict_p (frv_packet.mems[i].cond, cond))
7140 if (true_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, VOIDmode,
7141 *x, rtx_varies_p))
7142 return 1;
7144 if (output_dependence (frv_packet.mems[i].mem, *x))
7145 return 1;
7149 /* The return values of calls aren't significant: they describe
7150 the effect of the call as a whole, not of the insn itself. */
7151 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (*x)) == CALL)
7153 if (for_each_rtx (&SET_SRC (*x), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, data))
7154 return 1;
7155 return -1;
7158 /* Check subexpressions. */
7159 return 0;
7163 /* Return true if something in X might depend on an instruction
7164 in the current packet. */
7166 static bool
7167 frv_registers_conflict_p (rtx x)
7169 regstate_t flags;
7171 flags = 0;
7172 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7174 if (for_each_rtx (&XEXP (x, 0), frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags))
7175 return true;
7177 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7178 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7180 return for_each_rtx (&x, frv_registers_conflict_p_1, &flags);
7184 /* A note_stores callback. DATA points to the regstate_t condition
7185 under which X is modified. Update FRV_PACKET accordingly. */
7187 static void
7188 frv_registers_update_1 (rtx x, rtx pat ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data)
7190 unsigned int regno;
7192 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
7193 FOR_EACH_REGNO (regno, x)
7194 frv_packet.regstate[regno] |= *(regstate_t *) data;
7196 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
7198 if (frv_packet.num_mems < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_packet.mems))
7200 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].mem = x;
7201 frv_packet.mems[frv_packet.num_mems].cond = *(regstate_t *) data;
7203 frv_packet.num_mems++;
7208 /* Update the register state information for an instruction whose
7209 body is X. */
7211 static void
7212 frv_registers_update (rtx x)
7214 regstate_t flags;
7216 flags = REGSTATE_MODIFIED;
7217 if (GET_CODE (x) == COND_EXEC)
7219 flags |= frv_cond_flags (XEXP (x, 0));
7220 x = XEXP (x, 1);
7222 note_stores (x, frv_registers_update_1, &flags);
7226 /* Initialize frv_packet for the start of a new packet. */
7228 static void
7229 frv_start_packet (void)
7231 enum frv_insn_group group;
7233 memset (frv_packet.regstate, 0, sizeof (frv_packet.regstate));
7234 frv_packet.num_mems = 0;
7235 frv_packet.num_insns = 0;
7236 for (group = 0; group < NUM_GROUPS; group++)
7237 frv_packet.groups[group].num_insns = 0;
7241 /* Likewise for the start of a new basic block. */
7243 static void
7244 frv_start_packet_block (void)
7246 state_reset (frv_packet.dfa_state);
7247 frv_start_packet ();
7251 /* Finish the current packet, if any, and start a new one. Call
7252 HANDLE_PACKET with FRV_PACKET describing the completed packet. */
7254 static void
7255 frv_finish_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7257 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0)
7259 handle_packet ();
7260 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7261 frv_start_packet ();
7266 /* Return true if INSN can be added to the current packet. Update
7267 the DFA state on success. */
7269 static bool
7270 frv_pack_insn_p (rtx insn)
7272 /* See if the packet is already as long as it can be. */
7273 if (frv_packet.num_insns == frv_packet.issue_rate)
7274 return false;
7276 /* If the scheduler thought that an instruction should start a packet,
7277 it's usually a good idea to believe it. It knows much more about
7278 the latencies than we do.
7280 There are some exceptions though:
7282 - Conditional instructions are scheduled on the assumption that
7283 they will be executed. This is usually a good thing, since it
7284 tends to avoid unnecessary stalls in the conditional code.
7285 But we want to pack conditional instructions as tightly as
7286 possible, in order to optimize the case where they aren't
7287 executed.
7289 - The scheduler will always put branches on their own, even
7290 if there's no real dependency.
7292 - There's no point putting a call in its own packet unless
7293 we have to. */
7294 if (frv_packet.num_insns > 0
7295 && GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
7296 && GET_MODE (insn) == TImode
7297 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != COND_EXEC)
7298 return false;
7300 /* Check for register conflicts. Don't do this for setlo since any
7301 conflict will be with the partnering sethi, with which it can
7302 be packed. */
7303 if (get_attr_type (insn) != TYPE_SETLO)
7304 if (frv_registers_conflict_p (PATTERN (insn)))
7305 return false;
7307 return state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, insn) < 0;
7311 /* Add instruction INSN to the current packet. */
7313 static void
7314 frv_add_insn_to_packet (rtx insn)
7316 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7318 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7319 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7320 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7322 frv_registers_update (PATTERN (insn));
7326 /* Insert INSN (a member of frv_nops[]) into the current packet. If the
7327 packet ends in a branch or call, insert the nop before it, otherwise
7328 add to the end. */
7330 static void
7331 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (rtx insn)
7333 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7334 rtx last;
7336 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[frv_unit_groups[frv_insn_unit (insn)]];
7337 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7338 if (GET_CODE (last) != INSN)
7340 insn = emit_insn_before (PATTERN (insn), last);
7341 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1] = insn;
7342 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = last;
7344 else
7346 insn = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (insn), last);
7347 frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns++] = insn;
7349 packet_group->insns[packet_group->num_insns++] = insn;
7353 /* If packing is enabled, divide the instructions into packets and
7354 return true. Call HANDLE_PACKET for each complete packet. */
7356 static bool
7357 frv_for_each_packet (void (*handle_packet) (void))
7359 rtx insn, next_insn;
7361 frv_packet.issue_rate = frv_issue_rate ();
7363 /* Early exit if we don't want to pack insns. */
7364 if (!optimize
7365 || !flag_schedule_insns_after_reload
7366 || !TARGET_VLIW_BRANCH
7367 || frv_packet.issue_rate == 1)
7368 return false;
7370 /* Set up the initial packing state. */
7371 dfa_start ();
7372 frv_packet.dfa_state = alloca (state_size ());
7374 frv_start_packet_block ();
7375 for (insn = get_insns (); insn != 0; insn = next_insn)
7377 enum rtx_code code;
7378 bool eh_insn_p;
7380 code = GET_CODE (insn);
7381 next_insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7383 if (code == CODE_LABEL)
7385 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7386 frv_start_packet_block ();
7389 if (INSN_P (insn))
7390 switch (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)))
7392 case USE:
7393 case CLOBBER:
7394 case ADDR_VEC:
7395 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
7396 break;
7398 default:
7399 /* Calls mustn't be packed on a TOMCAT. */
7400 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN && frv_cpu_type == FRV_CPU_TOMCAT)
7401 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7403 /* Since the last instruction in a packet determines the EH
7404 region, any exception-throwing instruction must come at
7405 the end of reordered packet. Insns that issue to a
7406 branch unit are bound to come last; for others it's
7407 too hard to predict. */
7408 eh_insn_p = (find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL) != NULL);
7409 if (eh_insn_p && !frv_issues_to_branch_unit_p (insn))
7410 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7412 /* Finish the current packet if we can't add INSN to it.
7413 Simulate cycles until INSN is ready to issue. */
7414 if (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7416 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7417 while (!frv_pack_insn_p (insn))
7418 state_transition (frv_packet.dfa_state, 0);
7421 /* Add the instruction to the packet. */
7422 frv_add_insn_to_packet (insn);
7424 /* Calls and jumps end a packet, as do insns that throw
7425 an exception. */
7426 if (code == CALL_INSN || code == JUMP_INSN || eh_insn_p)
7427 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7428 break;
7431 frv_finish_packet (handle_packet);
7432 dfa_finish ();
7433 return true;
7436 /* Subroutine of frv_sort_insn_group. We are trying to sort
7437 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[0...NUM_INSNS-1] into assembly
7438 language order. We have already picked a new position for
7439 frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[X] if bit X of ISSUED is set.
7440 These instructions will occupy elements [0, LOWER_SLOT) and
7441 [UPPER_SLOT, NUM_INSNS) of the final (sorted) array. STATE is
7442 the DFA state after issuing these instructions.
7444 Try filling elements [LOWER_SLOT, UPPER_SLOT) with every permutation
7445 of the unused instructions. Return true if one such permutation gives
7446 a valid ordering, leaving the successful permutation in sorted[].
7447 Do not modify sorted[] until a valid permutation is found. */
7449 static bool
7450 frv_sort_insn_group_1 (enum frv_insn_group group,
7451 unsigned int lower_slot, unsigned int upper_slot,
7452 unsigned int issued, unsigned int num_insns,
7453 state_t state)
7455 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7456 unsigned int i;
7457 state_t test_state;
7458 size_t dfa_size;
7459 rtx insn;
7461 /* Early success if we've filled all the slots. */
7462 if (lower_slot == upper_slot)
7463 return true;
7465 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7466 dfa_size = state_size ();
7467 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7469 /* Try issuing each unused instruction. */
7470 for (i = num_insns - 1; i + 1 != 0; i--)
7471 if (~issued & (1 << i))
7473 insn = packet_group->sorted[i];
7474 memcpy (test_state, state, dfa_size);
7475 if (state_transition (test_state, insn) < 0
7476 && cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state,
7477 NTH_UNIT (group, upper_slot - 1))
7478 && frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, lower_slot, upper_slot - 1,
7479 issued | (1 << i), num_insns,
7480 test_state))
7482 packet_group->sorted[upper_slot - 1] = insn;
7483 return true;
7487 return false;
7490 /* Compare two instructions by their frv_insn_unit. */
7492 static int
7493 frv_compare_insns (const void *first, const void *second)
7495 const rtx *insn1 = first, *insn2 = second;
7496 return frv_insn_unit (*insn1) - frv_insn_unit (*insn2);
7499 /* Copy frv_packet.groups[GROUP].insns[] to frv_packet.groups[GROUP].sorted[]
7500 and sort it into assembly language order. See frv.md for a description of
7501 the algorithm. */
7503 static void
7504 frv_sort_insn_group (enum frv_insn_group group)
7506 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7507 unsigned int first, i, nop, max_unit, num_slots;
7508 state_t state, test_state;
7509 size_t dfa_size;
7511 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7513 /* Assume no nop is needed. */
7514 packet_group->nop = 0;
7516 if (packet_group->num_insns == 0)
7517 return;
7519 /* Copy insns[] to sorted[]. */
7520 memcpy (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->insns,
7521 sizeof (rtx) * packet_group->num_insns);
7523 /* Sort sorted[] by the unit that each insn tries to take first. */
7524 if (packet_group->num_insns > 1)
7525 qsort (packet_group->sorted, packet_group->num_insns,
7526 sizeof (rtx), frv_compare_insns);
7528 /* That's always enough for branch and control insns. */
7529 if (group == GROUP_B || group == GROUP_C)
7530 return;
7532 dfa_size = state_size ();
7533 state = alloca (dfa_size);
7534 test_state = alloca (dfa_size);
7536 /* Find the highest FIRST such that sorted[0...FIRST-1] can issue
7537 consecutively and such that the DFA takes unit X when sorted[X]
7538 is added. Set STATE to the new DFA state. */
7539 state_reset (test_state);
7540 for (first = 0; first < packet_group->num_insns; first++)
7542 memcpy (state, test_state, dfa_size);
7543 if (state_transition (test_state, packet_group->sorted[first]) >= 0
7544 || !cpu_unit_reservation_p (test_state, NTH_UNIT (group, first)))
7545 break;
7548 /* If all the instructions issued in ascending order, we're done. */
7549 if (first == packet_group->num_insns)
7550 return;
7552 /* Add nops to the end of sorted[] and try each permutation until
7553 we find one that works. */
7554 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
7556 max_unit = frv_insn_unit (frv_nops[nop]);
7557 if (frv_unit_groups[max_unit] == group)
7559 packet_group->nop = frv_nops[nop];
7560 num_slots = UNIT_NUMBER (max_unit) + 1;
7561 for (i = packet_group->num_insns; i < num_slots; i++)
7562 packet_group->sorted[i] = frv_nops[nop];
7563 if (frv_sort_insn_group_1 (group, first, num_slots,
7564 (1 << first) - 1, num_slots, state))
7565 return;
7568 gcc_unreachable ();
7571 /* Sort the current packet into assembly-language order. Set packing
7572 flags as appropriate. */
7574 static void
7575 frv_reorder_packet (void)
7577 unsigned int cursor[NUM_GROUPS];
7578 rtx insns[ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups)];
7579 unsigned int unit, to, from;
7580 enum frv_insn_group group;
7581 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7583 /* First sort each group individually. */
7584 for (group = 0; group < NUM_GROUPS; group++)
7586 cursor[group] = 0;
7587 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7590 /* Go through the unit template and try add an instruction from
7591 that unit's group. */
7592 to = 0;
7593 for (unit = 0; unit < ARRAY_SIZE (frv_unit_groups); unit++)
7595 group = frv_unit_groups[unit];
7596 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7597 if (cursor[group] < packet_group->num_insns)
7599 /* frv_reorg should have added nops for us. */
7600 gcc_assert (packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]]
7601 != packet_group->nop);
7602 insns[to++] = packet_group->sorted[cursor[group]++];
7606 gcc_assert (to == frv_packet.num_insns);
7608 /* Clear the last instruction's packing flag, thus marking the end of
7609 a packet. Reorder the other instructions relative to it. */
7610 CLEAR_PACKING_FLAG (insns[to - 1]);
7611 for (from = 0; from < to - 1; from++)
7613 remove_insn (insns[from]);
7614 add_insn_before (insns[from], insns[to - 1]);
7615 SET_PACKING_FLAG (insns[from]);
7620 /* Divide instructions into packets. Reorder the contents of each
7621 packet so that they are in the correct assembly-language order.
7623 Since this pass can change the raw meaning of the rtl stream, it must
7624 only be called at the last minute, just before the instructions are
7625 written out. */
7627 static void
7628 frv_pack_insns (void)
7630 if (frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorder_packet))
7631 frv_insn_packing_flag = 0;
7632 else
7633 frv_insn_packing_flag = -1;
7636 /* See whether we need to add nops to group GROUP in order to
7637 make a valid packet. */
7639 static void
7640 frv_fill_unused_units (enum frv_insn_group group)
7642 unsigned int non_nops, nops, i;
7643 struct frv_packet_group *packet_group;
7645 packet_group = &frv_packet.groups[group];
7647 /* Sort the instructions into assembly-language order.
7648 Use nops to fill slots that are otherwise unused. */
7649 frv_sort_insn_group (group);
7651 /* See how many nops are needed before the final useful instruction. */
7652 i = nops = 0;
7653 for (non_nops = 0; non_nops < packet_group->num_insns; non_nops++)
7654 while (packet_group->sorted[i++] == packet_group->nop)
7655 nops++;
7657 /* Insert that many nops into the instruction stream. */
7658 while (nops-- > 0)
7659 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (packet_group->nop);
7662 /* Used by frv_reorg to keep track of the current packet's address. */
7663 static unsigned int frv_packet_address;
7665 /* If the current packet falls through to a label, try to pad the packet
7666 with nops in order to fit the label's alignment requirements. */
7668 static void
7669 frv_align_label (void)
7671 unsigned int alignment, target, nop;
7672 rtx x, last, barrier, label;
7674 /* Walk forward to the start of the next packet. Set ALIGNMENT to the
7675 maximum alignment of that packet, LABEL to the last label between
7676 the packets, and BARRIER to the last barrier. */
7677 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7678 label = barrier = 0;
7679 alignment = 4;
7680 for (x = NEXT_INSN (last); x != 0 && !INSN_P (x); x = NEXT_INSN (x))
7682 if (LABEL_P (x))
7684 unsigned int subalign = 1 << label_to_alignment (x);
7685 alignment = MAX (alignment, subalign);
7686 label = x;
7688 if (BARRIER_P (x))
7689 barrier = x;
7692 /* If -malign-labels, and the packet falls through to an unaligned
7693 label, try introducing a nop to align that label to 8 bytes. */
7694 if (TARGET_ALIGN_LABELS
7695 && label != 0
7696 && barrier == 0
7697 && frv_packet.num_insns < frv_packet.issue_rate)
7698 alignment = MAX (alignment, 8);
7700 /* Advance the address to the end of the current packet. */
7701 frv_packet_address += frv_packet.num_insns * 4;
7703 /* Work out the target address, after alignment. */
7704 target = (frv_packet_address + alignment - 1) & -alignment;
7706 /* If the packet falls through to the label, try to find an efficient
7707 padding sequence. */
7708 if (barrier == 0)
7710 /* First try adding nops to the current packet. */
7711 for (nop = 0; nop < frv_num_nops; nop++)
7712 while (frv_packet_address < target && frv_pack_insn_p (frv_nops[nop]))
7714 frv_insert_nop_in_packet (frv_nops[nop]);
7715 frv_packet_address += 4;
7718 /* If we still haven't reached the target, add some new packets that
7719 contain only nops. If there are two types of nop, insert an
7720 alternating sequence of frv_nops[0] and frv_nops[1], which will
7721 lead to packets like:
7723 nop.p
7724 mnop.p/fnop.p
7725 nop.p
7726 mnop/fnop
7728 etc. Just emit frv_nops[0] if that's the only nop we have. */
7729 last = frv_packet.insns[frv_packet.num_insns - 1];
7730 nop = 0;
7731 while (frv_packet_address < target)
7733 last = emit_insn_after (PATTERN (frv_nops[nop]), last);
7734 frv_packet_address += 4;
7735 if (frv_num_nops > 1)
7736 nop ^= 1;
7740 frv_packet_address = target;
7743 /* Subroutine of frv_reorg, called after each packet has been constructed
7744 in frv_packet. */
7746 static void
7747 frv_reorg_packet (void)
7749 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_I);
7750 frv_fill_unused_units (GROUP_FM);
7751 frv_align_label ();
7754 /* Add an instruction with pattern NOP to frv_nops[]. */
7756 static void
7757 frv_register_nop (rtx nop)
7759 nop = make_insn_raw (nop);
7760 NEXT_INSN (nop) = 0;
7761 PREV_INSN (nop) = 0;
7762 frv_nops[frv_num_nops++] = nop;
7765 /* Implement TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG. Divide the instructions
7766 into packets and check whether we need to insert nops in order to
7767 fulfill the processor's issue requirements. Also, if the user has
7768 requested a certain alignment for a label, try to meet that alignment
7769 by inserting nops in the previous packet. */
7771 static void
7772 frv_reorg (void)
7774 frv_num_nops = 0;
7775 frv_register_nop (gen_nop ());
7776 if (TARGET_MEDIA)
7777 frv_register_nop (gen_mnop ());
7778 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
7779 frv_register_nop (gen_fnop ());
7781 /* Estimate the length of each branch. Although this may change after
7782 we've inserted nops, it will only do so in big functions. */
7783 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
7785 frv_packet_address = 0;
7786 frv_for_each_packet (frv_reorg_packet);
7789 #define def_builtin(name, type, code) \
7790 lang_hooks.builtin_function ((name), (type), (code), BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL)
7792 struct builtin_description
7794 enum insn_code icode;
7795 const char *name;
7796 enum frv_builtins code;
7797 enum rtx_code comparison;
7798 unsigned int flag;
7801 /* Media intrinsics that take a single, constant argument. */
7803 static struct builtin_description bdesc_set[] =
7805 { CODE_FOR_mhdsets, "__MHDSETS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS, 0, 0 }
7808 /* Media intrinsics that take just one argument. */
7810 static struct builtin_description bdesc_1arg[] =
7812 { CODE_FOR_mnot, "__MNOT", FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT, 0, 0 },
7813 { CODE_FOR_munpackh, "__MUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH, 0, 0 },
7814 { CODE_FOR_mbtoh, "__MBTOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH, 0, 0 },
7815 { CODE_FOR_mhtob, "__MHTOB", FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB, 0, 0 },
7816 { CODE_FOR_mabshs, "__MABSHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS, 0, 0 },
7817 { CODE_FOR_scutss, "__SCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS, 0, 0 }
7820 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments. */
7822 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2arg[] =
7824 { CODE_FOR_mand, "__MAND", FRV_BUILTIN_MAND, 0, 0 },
7825 { CODE_FOR_mor, "__MOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MOR, 0, 0 },
7826 { CODE_FOR_mxor, "__MXOR", FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR, 0, 0 },
7827 { CODE_FOR_maveh, "__MAVEH", FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH, 0, 0 },
7828 { CODE_FOR_msaths, "__MSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS, 0, 0 },
7829 { CODE_FOR_msathu, "__MSATHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU, 0, 0 },
7830 { CODE_FOR_maddhss, "__MADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS, 0, 0 },
7831 { CODE_FOR_maddhus, "__MADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS, 0, 0 },
7832 { CODE_FOR_msubhss, "__MSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS, 0, 0 },
7833 { CODE_FOR_msubhus, "__MSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS, 0, 0 },
7834 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhss, "__MQADDHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS, 0, 0 },
7835 { CODE_FOR_mqaddhus, "__MQADDHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS, 0, 0 },
7836 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhss, "__MQSUBHSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS, 0, 0 },
7837 { CODE_FOR_mqsubhus, "__MQSUBHUS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS, 0, 0 },
7838 { CODE_FOR_mpackh, "__MPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH, 0, 0 },
7839 { CODE_FOR_mcop1, "__Mcop1", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1, 0, 0 },
7840 { CODE_FOR_mcop2, "__Mcop2", FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2, 0, 0 },
7841 { CODE_FOR_mwcut, "__MWCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT, 0, 0 },
7842 { CODE_FOR_mqsaths, "__MQSATHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS, 0, 0 },
7843 { CODE_FOR_mqlclrhs, "__MQLCLRHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS, 0, 0 },
7844 { CODE_FOR_mqlmths, "__MQLMTHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS, 0, 0 },
7845 { CODE_FOR_smul, "__SMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL, 0, 0 },
7846 { CODE_FOR_umul, "__UMUL", FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL, 0, 0 },
7847 { CODE_FOR_addss, "__ADDSS", FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS, 0, 0 },
7848 { CODE_FOR_subss, "__SUBSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS, 0, 0 },
7849 { CODE_FOR_slass, "__SLASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS, 0, 0 },
7850 { CODE_FOR_scan, "__SCAN", FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN, 0, 0 }
7853 /* Integer intrinsics that take two arguments and have no return value. */
7855 static struct builtin_description bdesc_int_void2arg[] =
7857 { CODE_FOR_smass, "__SMASS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS, 0, 0 },
7858 { CODE_FOR_smsss, "__SMSSS", FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS, 0, 0 },
7859 { CODE_FOR_smu, "__SMU", FRV_BUILTIN_SMU, 0, 0 }
7862 static struct builtin_description bdesc_prefetches[] =
7864 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch0, "__data_prefetch0", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0, 0, 0 },
7865 { CODE_FOR_frv_prefetch, "__data_prefetch", FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH, 0, 0 }
7868 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments, the first being an ACC number. */
7870 static struct builtin_description bdesc_cut[] =
7872 { CODE_FOR_mcut, "__MCUT", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT, 0, 0 },
7873 { CODE_FOR_mcutss, "__MCUTSS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS, 0, 0 },
7874 { CODE_FOR_mdcutssi, "__MDCUTSSI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI, 0, 0 }
7877 /* Two-argument media intrinsics with an immediate second argument. */
7879 static struct builtin_description bdesc_2argimm[] =
7881 { CODE_FOR_mrotli, "__MROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI, 0, 0 },
7882 { CODE_FOR_mrotri, "__MROTRI", FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI, 0, 0 },
7883 { CODE_FOR_msllhi, "__MSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI, 0, 0 },
7884 { CODE_FOR_msrlhi, "__MSRLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI, 0, 0 },
7885 { CODE_FOR_msrahi, "__MSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI, 0, 0 },
7886 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhw, "__MEXPDHW", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW, 0, 0 },
7887 { CODE_FOR_mexpdhd, "__MEXPDHD", FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD, 0, 0 },
7888 { CODE_FOR_mdrotli, "__MDROTLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI, 0, 0 },
7889 { CODE_FOR_mcplhi, "__MCPLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI, 0, 0 },
7890 { CODE_FOR_mcpli, "__MCPLI", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI, 0, 0 },
7891 { CODE_FOR_mhsetlos, "__MHSETLOS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS, 0, 0 },
7892 { CODE_FOR_mhsetloh, "__MHSETLOH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH, 0, 0 },
7893 { CODE_FOR_mhsethis, "__MHSETHIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS, 0, 0 },
7894 { CODE_FOR_mhsethih, "__MHSETHIH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH, 0, 0 },
7895 { CODE_FOR_mhdseth, "__MHDSETH", FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH, 0, 0 },
7896 { CODE_FOR_mqsllhi, "__MQSLLHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI, 0, 0 },
7897 { CODE_FOR_mqsrahi, "__MQSRAHI", FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI, 0, 0 }
7900 /* Media intrinsics that take two arguments and return void, the first argument
7901 being a pointer to 4 words in memory. */
7903 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void2arg[] =
7905 { CODE_FOR_mdunpackh, "__MDUNPACKH", FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH, 0, 0 },
7906 { CODE_FOR_mbtohe, "__MBTOHE", FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE, 0, 0 },
7909 /* Media intrinsics that take three arguments, the first being a const_int that
7910 denotes an accumulator, and that return void. */
7912 static struct builtin_description bdesc_void3arg[] =
7914 { CODE_FOR_mcpxrs, "__MCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS, 0, 0 },
7915 { CODE_FOR_mcpxru, "__MCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU, 0, 0 },
7916 { CODE_FOR_mcpxis, "__MCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS, 0, 0 },
7917 { CODE_FOR_mcpxiu, "__MCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU, 0, 0 },
7918 { CODE_FOR_mmulhs, "__MMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS, 0, 0 },
7919 { CODE_FOR_mmulhu, "__MMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU, 0, 0 },
7920 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhs, "__MMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS, 0, 0 },
7921 { CODE_FOR_mmulxhu, "__MMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU, 0, 0 },
7922 { CODE_FOR_mmachs, "__MMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS, 0, 0 },
7923 { CODE_FOR_mmachu, "__MMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU, 0, 0 },
7924 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhs, "__MMRDHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS, 0, 0 },
7925 { CODE_FOR_mmrdhu, "__MMRDHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU, 0, 0 },
7926 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxrs, "__MQCPXRS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS, 0, 0 },
7927 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxru, "__MQCPXRU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU, 0, 0 },
7928 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxis, "__MQCPXIS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS, 0, 0 },
7929 { CODE_FOR_mqcpxiu, "__MQCPXIU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU, 0, 0 },
7930 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhs, "__MQMULHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS, 0, 0 },
7931 { CODE_FOR_mqmulhu, "__MQMULHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU, 0, 0 },
7932 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhs, "__MQMULXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS, 0, 0 },
7933 { CODE_FOR_mqmulxhu, "__MQMULXHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU, 0, 0 },
7934 { CODE_FOR_mqmachs, "__MQMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS, 0, 0 },
7935 { CODE_FOR_mqmachu, "__MQMACHU", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU, 0, 0 },
7936 { CODE_FOR_mqxmachs, "__MQXMACHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS, 0, 0 },
7937 { CODE_FOR_mqxmacxhs, "__MQXMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS, 0, 0 },
7938 { CODE_FOR_mqmacxhs, "__MQMACXHS", FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS, 0, 0 }
7941 /* Media intrinsics that take two accumulator numbers as argument and
7942 return void. */
7944 static struct builtin_description bdesc_voidacc[] =
7946 { CODE_FOR_maddaccs, "__MADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS, 0, 0 },
7947 { CODE_FOR_msubaccs, "__MSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS, 0, 0 },
7948 { CODE_FOR_masaccs, "__MASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS, 0, 0 },
7949 { CODE_FOR_mdaddaccs, "__MDADDACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS, 0, 0 },
7950 { CODE_FOR_mdsubaccs, "__MDSUBACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS, 0, 0 },
7951 { CODE_FOR_mdasaccs, "__MDASACCS", FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS, 0, 0 }
7954 /* Initialize media builtins. */
7956 static void
7957 frv_init_builtins (void)
7959 tree endlink = void_list_node;
7960 tree accumulator = integer_type_node;
7961 tree integer = integer_type_node;
7962 tree voidt = void_type_node;
7963 tree uhalf = short_unsigned_type_node;
7964 tree sword1 = long_integer_type_node;
7965 tree uword1 = long_unsigned_type_node;
7966 tree sword2 = long_long_integer_type_node;
7967 tree uword2 = long_long_unsigned_type_node;
7968 tree uword4 = build_pointer_type (uword1);
7969 tree iacc = integer_type_node;
7971 #define UNARY(RET, T1) \
7972 build_function_type (RET, tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T1, endlink))
7974 #define BINARY(RET, T1, T2) \
7975 build_function_type (RET, tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T1, \
7976 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T2, endlink)))
7978 #define TRINARY(RET, T1, T2, T3) \
7979 build_function_type (RET, tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T1, \
7980 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T2, \
7981 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T3, endlink))))
7983 #define QUAD(RET, T1, T2, T3, T4) \
7984 build_function_type (RET, tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T1, \
7985 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T2, \
7986 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T3, \
7987 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, T4, endlink)))))
7989 tree void_ftype_void = build_function_type (voidt, endlink);
7991 tree void_ftype_acc = UNARY (voidt, accumulator);
7992 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword1);
7993 tree void_ftype_uw4_uw2 = BINARY (voidt, uword4, uword2);
7994 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1);
7995 tree void_ftype_acc_acc = BINARY (voidt, accumulator, accumulator);
7996 tree void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword1, uword1);
7997 tree void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword1, sword1);
7998 tree void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, uword2, uword2);
7999 tree void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2 = TRINARY (voidt, accumulator, sword2, sword2);
8001 tree uw1_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword1, uword1);
8002 tree uw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (uword1, sword1);
8003 tree uw1_ftype_uw2 = UNARY (uword1, uword2);
8004 tree uw1_ftype_acc = UNARY (uword1, accumulator);
8005 tree uw1_ftype_uh_uh = BINARY (uword1, uhalf, uhalf);
8006 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword1, uword1);
8007 tree uw1_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword1, uword1, integer);
8008 tree uw1_ftype_acc_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, uword1);
8009 tree uw1_ftype_acc_sw1 = BINARY (uword1, accumulator, sword1);
8010 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1 = BINARY (uword1, uword2, uword1);
8011 tree uw1_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword1, uword2, integer);
8013 tree sw1_ftype_int = UNARY (sword1, integer);
8014 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword1, sword1, sword1);
8015 tree sw1_ftype_sw1_int = BINARY (sword1, sword1, integer);
8017 tree uw2_ftype_uw1 = UNARY (uword2, uword1);
8018 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_int = BINARY (uword2, uword1, integer);
8019 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2 = BINARY (uword2, uword2, uword2);
8020 tree uw2_ftype_uw2_int = BINARY (uword2, uword2, integer);
8021 tree uw2_ftype_acc_int = BINARY (uword2, accumulator, integer);
8022 tree uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh = QUAD (uword2, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf, uhalf);
8024 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2 = BINARY (sword2, sword2, sword2);
8025 tree sw2_ftype_sw2_int = BINARY (sword2, sword2, integer);
8026 tree uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1 = BINARY (uword2, uword1, uword1);
8027 tree sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (sword2, sword1, sword1);
8028 tree void_ftype_sw1_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, sword1, sword1);
8029 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw2 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword2);
8030 tree void_ftype_iacc_sw1 = BINARY (voidt, iacc, sword1);
8031 tree sw1_ftype_sw1 = UNARY (sword1, sword1);
8032 tree sw2_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword2, iacc);
8033 tree sw1_ftype_iacc = UNARY (sword1, iacc);
8034 tree void_ftype_ptr = UNARY (voidt, const_ptr_type_node);
8036 def_builtin ("__MAND", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAND);
8037 def_builtin ("__MOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MOR);
8038 def_builtin ("__MXOR", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MXOR);
8039 def_builtin ("__MNOT", uw1_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MNOT);
8040 def_builtin ("__MROTLI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTLI);
8041 def_builtin ("__MROTRI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MROTRI);
8042 def_builtin ("__MWCUT", uw1_ftype_uw2_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWCUT);
8043 def_builtin ("__MAVEH", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MAVEH);
8044 def_builtin ("__MSLLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSLLHI);
8045 def_builtin ("__MSRLHI", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRLHI);
8046 def_builtin ("__MSRAHI", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MSRAHI);
8047 def_builtin ("__MSATHS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHS);
8048 def_builtin ("__MSATHU", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSATHU);
8049 def_builtin ("__MADDHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHSS);
8050 def_builtin ("__MADDHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDHUS);
8051 def_builtin ("__MSUBHSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHSS);
8052 def_builtin ("__MSUBHUS", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBHUS);
8053 def_builtin ("__MMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHS);
8054 def_builtin ("__MMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULHU);
8055 def_builtin ("__MMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHS);
8056 def_builtin ("__MMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMULXHU);
8057 def_builtin ("__MMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHS);
8058 def_builtin ("__MMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMACHU);
8059 def_builtin ("__MMRDHS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHS);
8060 def_builtin ("__MMRDHU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MMRDHU);
8061 def_builtin ("__MQADDHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHSS);
8062 def_builtin ("__MQADDHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQADDHUS);
8063 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHSS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHSS);
8064 def_builtin ("__MQSUBHUS", uw2_ftype_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSUBHUS);
8065 def_builtin ("__MQMULHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHS);
8066 def_builtin ("__MQMULHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULHU);
8067 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHS);
8068 def_builtin ("__MQMULXHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMULXHU);
8069 def_builtin ("__MQMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHS);
8070 def_builtin ("__MQMACHU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACHU);
8071 def_builtin ("__MCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRS);
8072 def_builtin ("__MCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXRU);
8073 def_builtin ("__MCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIS);
8074 def_builtin ("__MCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPXIU);
8075 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRS);
8076 def_builtin ("__MQCPXRU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXRU);
8077 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIS);
8078 def_builtin ("__MQCPXIU", void_ftype_acc_uw2_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQCPXIU);
8079 def_builtin ("__MCUT", uw1_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUT);
8080 def_builtin ("__MCUTSS", uw1_ftype_acc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCUTSS);
8081 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHW", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHW);
8082 def_builtin ("__MEXPDHD", uw2_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MEXPDHD);
8083 def_builtin ("__MPACKH", uw1_ftype_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MPACKH);
8084 def_builtin ("__MUNPACKH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MUNPACKH);
8085 def_builtin ("__MDPACKH", uw2_ftype_uh_uh_uh_uh, FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH);
8086 def_builtin ("__MDUNPACKH", void_ftype_uw4_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH);
8087 def_builtin ("__MBTOH", uw2_ftype_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOH);
8088 def_builtin ("__MHTOB", uw1_ftype_uw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MHTOB);
8089 def_builtin ("__MBTOHE", void_ftype_uw4_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE);
8090 def_builtin ("__MCLRACC", void_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC);
8091 def_builtin ("__MCLRACCA", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA);
8092 def_builtin ("__MRDACC", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC);
8093 def_builtin ("__MRDACCG", uw1_ftype_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG);
8094 def_builtin ("__MWTACC", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC);
8095 def_builtin ("__MWTACCG", void_ftype_acc_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG);
8096 def_builtin ("__Mcop1", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1);
8097 def_builtin ("__Mcop2", uw1_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2);
8098 def_builtin ("__MTRAP", void_ftype_void, FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP);
8099 def_builtin ("__MQXMACHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS);
8100 def_builtin ("__MQXMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS);
8101 def_builtin ("__MQMACXHS", void_ftype_acc_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS);
8102 def_builtin ("__MADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS);
8103 def_builtin ("__MSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS);
8104 def_builtin ("__MASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS);
8105 def_builtin ("__MDADDACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS);
8106 def_builtin ("__MDSUBACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS);
8107 def_builtin ("__MDASACCS", void_ftype_acc_acc, FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS);
8108 def_builtin ("__MABSHS", uw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS);
8109 def_builtin ("__MDROTLI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI);
8110 def_builtin ("__MCPLHI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI);
8111 def_builtin ("__MCPLI", uw1_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI);
8112 def_builtin ("__MDCUTSSI", uw2_ftype_acc_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI);
8113 def_builtin ("__MQSATHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS);
8114 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS);
8115 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIS", sw1_ftype_sw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS);
8116 def_builtin ("__MHDSETS", sw1_ftype_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS);
8117 def_builtin ("__MHSETLOH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH);
8118 def_builtin ("__MHSETHIH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH);
8119 def_builtin ("__MHDSETH", uw1_ftype_uw1_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH);
8120 def_builtin ("__MQLCLRHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS);
8121 def_builtin ("__MQLMTHS", sw2_ftype_sw2_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS);
8122 def_builtin ("__MQSLLHI", uw2_ftype_uw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI);
8123 def_builtin ("__MQSRAHI", sw2_ftype_sw2_int, FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI);
8124 def_builtin ("__SMUL", sw2_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMUL);
8125 def_builtin ("__UMUL", uw2_ftype_uw1_uw1, FRV_BUILTIN_UMUL);
8126 def_builtin ("__SMASS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS);
8127 def_builtin ("__SMSSS", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS);
8128 def_builtin ("__SMU", void_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SMU);
8129 def_builtin ("__ADDSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS);
8130 def_builtin ("__SUBSS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS);
8131 def_builtin ("__SLASS", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS);
8132 def_builtin ("__SCAN", sw1_ftype_sw1_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCAN);
8133 def_builtin ("__SCUTSS", sw1_ftype_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS);
8134 def_builtin ("__IACCreadll", sw2_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll);
8135 def_builtin ("__IACCreadl", sw1_ftype_iacc, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl);
8136 def_builtin ("__IACCsetll", void_ftype_iacc_sw2, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll);
8137 def_builtin ("__IACCsetl", void_ftype_iacc_sw1, FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl);
8138 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch0", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH0);
8139 def_builtin ("__data_prefetch", void_ftype_ptr, FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH);
8141 #undef UNARY
8142 #undef BINARY
8143 #undef TRINARY
8144 #undef QUAD
8147 /* Set the names for various arithmetic operations according to the
8148 FRV ABI. */
8149 static void
8150 frv_init_libfuncs (void)
8152 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "__modi");
8153 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "__umodi");
8155 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DImode, "__addll");
8156 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DImode, "__subll");
8157 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DImode, "__mulll");
8158 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "__divll");
8159 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "__modll");
8160 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "__umodll");
8161 set_optab_libfunc (and_optab, DImode, "__andll");
8162 set_optab_libfunc (ior_optab, DImode, "__orll");
8163 set_optab_libfunc (xor_optab, DImode, "__xorll");
8164 set_optab_libfunc (one_cmpl_optab, DImode, "__notll");
8166 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__addf");
8167 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__subf");
8168 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__mulf");
8169 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__divf");
8171 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__addd");
8172 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__subd");
8173 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__muld");
8174 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__divd");
8176 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__ftod");
8177 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__dtof");
8179 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoi");
8180 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoll");
8181 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoi");
8182 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoll");
8184 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__ftoui");
8185 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__ftoull");
8186 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__dtoui");
8187 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__dtoull");
8189 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__itof");
8190 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__lltof");
8191 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__itod");
8192 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__lltod");
8195 /* Convert an integer constant to an accumulator register. ICODE is the
8196 code of the target instruction, OPNUM is the number of the
8197 accumulator operand and OPVAL is the constant integer. Try both
8198 ACC and ACCG registers; only report an error if neither fit the
8199 instruction. */
8201 static rtx
8202 frv_int_to_acc (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8204 rtx reg;
8205 int i;
8207 /* ACCs and ACCGs are implicit global registers if media intrinsics
8208 are being used. We set up this lazily to avoid creating lots of
8209 unnecessary call_insn rtl in non-media code. */
8210 for (i = 0; i <= ACC_MASK; i++)
8211 if ((i & ACC_MASK) == i)
8212 global_regs[i + ACC_FIRST] = global_regs[i + ACCG_FIRST] = 1;
8214 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8216 error ("accumulator is not a constant integer");
8217 return NULL_RTX;
8219 if ((INTVAL (opval) & ~ACC_MASK) != 0)
8221 error ("accumulator number is out of bounds");
8222 return NULL_RTX;
8225 reg = gen_rtx_REG (insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode,
8226 ACC_FIRST + INTVAL (opval));
8227 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8228 REGNO (reg) = ACCG_FIRST + INTVAL (opval);
8230 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (reg, VOIDmode))
8232 error ("inappropriate accumulator for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8233 return NULL_RTX;
8235 return reg;
8238 /* If an ACC rtx has mode MODE, return the mode that the matching ACCG
8239 should have. */
8241 static enum machine_mode
8242 frv_matching_accg_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
8244 switch (mode)
8246 case V4SImode:
8247 return V4QImode;
8249 case DImode:
8250 return HImode;
8252 case SImode:
8253 return QImode;
8255 default:
8256 gcc_unreachable ();
8260 /* Return the accumulator guard that should be paired with accumulator
8261 register ACC. The mode of the returned register is in the same
8262 class as ACC, but is four times smaller. */
8265 frv_matching_accg_for_acc (rtx acc)
8267 return gen_rtx_REG (frv_matching_accg_mode (GET_MODE (acc)),
8268 REGNO (acc) - ACC_FIRST + ACCG_FIRST);
8271 /* Read a value from the head of the tree list pointed to by ARGLISTPTR.
8272 Return the value as an rtx and replace *ARGLISTPTR with the tail of the
8273 list. */
8275 static rtx
8276 frv_read_argument (tree *arglistptr)
8278 tree next = TREE_VALUE (*arglistptr);
8279 *arglistptr = TREE_CHAIN (*arglistptr);
8280 return expand_expr (next, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
8283 /* Like frv_read_argument, but interpret the argument as the number
8284 of an IACC register and return a (reg:MODE ...) rtx for it. */
8286 static rtx
8287 frv_read_iacc_argument (enum machine_mode mode, tree *arglistptr)
8289 int i, regno;
8290 rtx op;
8292 op = frv_read_argument (arglistptr);
8293 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST_INT
8294 || INTVAL (op) < 0
8295 || INTVAL (op) > IACC_LAST - IACC_FIRST
8296 || ((INTVAL (op) * 4) & (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1)) != 0)
8298 error ("invalid IACC argument");
8299 op = const0_rtx;
8302 /* IACCs are implicit global registers. We set up this lazily to
8303 avoid creating lots of unnecessary call_insn rtl when IACCs aren't
8304 being used. */
8305 regno = INTVAL (op) + IACC_FIRST;
8306 for (i = 0; i < HARD_REGNO_NREGS (regno, mode); i++)
8307 global_regs[regno + i] = 1;
8309 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regno);
8312 /* Return true if OPVAL can be used for operand OPNUM of instruction ICODE.
8313 The instruction should require a constant operand of some sort. The
8314 function prints an error if OPVAL is not valid. */
8316 static int
8317 frv_check_constant_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx opval)
8319 if (GET_CODE (opval) != CONST_INT)
8321 error ("%qs expects a constant argument", insn_data[icode].name);
8322 return FALSE;
8324 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (opval, VOIDmode))
8326 error ("constant argument out of range for %qs", insn_data[icode].name);
8327 return FALSE;
8329 return TRUE;
8332 /* Return a legitimate rtx for instruction ICODE's return value. Use TARGET
8333 if it's not null, has the right mode, and satisfies operand 0's
8334 predicate. */
8336 static rtx
8337 frv_legitimize_target (enum insn_code icode, rtx target)
8339 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8341 if (! target
8342 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8343 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, mode))
8344 return gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8345 else
8346 return target;
8349 /* Given that ARG is being passed as operand OPNUM to instruction ICODE,
8350 check whether ARG satisfies the operand's constraints. If it doesn't,
8351 copy ARG to a temporary register and return that. Otherwise return ARG
8352 itself. */
8354 static rtx
8355 frv_legitimize_argument (enum insn_code icode, int opnum, rtx arg)
8357 enum machine_mode mode = insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].mode;
8359 if ((*insn_data[icode].operand[opnum].predicate) (arg, mode))
8360 return arg;
8361 else
8362 return copy_to_mode_reg (mode, arg);
8365 /* Expand builtins that take a single, constant argument. At the moment,
8366 only MHDSETS falls into this category. */
8368 static rtx
8369 frv_expand_set_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist, rtx target)
8371 rtx pat;
8372 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8374 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 1, op0))
8375 return NULL_RTX;
8377 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8378 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8379 if (! pat)
8380 return NULL_RTX;
8382 emit_insn (pat);
8383 return target;
8386 /* Expand builtins that take one operand. */
8388 static rtx
8389 frv_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist, rtx target)
8391 rtx pat;
8392 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8394 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8395 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8396 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8397 if (! pat)
8398 return NULL_RTX;
8400 emit_insn (pat);
8401 return target;
8404 /* Expand builtins that take two operands. */
8406 static rtx
8407 frv_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist, rtx target)
8409 rtx pat;
8410 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8411 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8413 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8414 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8415 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8416 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8417 if (! pat)
8418 return NULL_RTX;
8420 emit_insn (pat);
8421 return target;
8424 /* Expand cut-style builtins, which take two operands and an implicit ACCG
8425 one. */
8427 static rtx
8428 frv_expand_cut_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist, rtx target)
8430 rtx pat;
8431 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8432 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8433 rtx op2;
8435 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8436 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
8437 if (! op0)
8438 return NULL_RTX;
8440 if (icode == CODE_FOR_mdcutssi || GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
8442 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8443 return NULL_RTX;
8445 else
8446 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op1);
8448 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8449 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
8450 if (! pat)
8451 return NULL_RTX;
8453 emit_insn (pat);
8454 return target;
8457 /* Expand builtins that take two operands and the second is immediate. */
8459 static rtx
8460 frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist, rtx target)
8462 rtx pat;
8463 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8464 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8466 if (! frv_check_constant_argument (icode, 2, op1))
8467 return NULL_RTX;
8469 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8470 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8471 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8472 if (! pat)
8473 return NULL_RTX;
8475 emit_insn (pat);
8476 return target;
8479 /* Expand builtins that take two operands, the first operand being a pointer to
8480 ints and return void. */
8482 static rtx
8483 frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8485 rtx pat;
8486 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8487 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8488 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
8489 rtx addr;
8491 if (GET_CODE (op0) != MEM)
8493 rtx reg = op0;
8495 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, op0))
8497 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
8498 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg, op0));
8501 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, reg);
8504 addr = XEXP (op0, 0);
8505 if (! offsettable_address_p (0, mode0, addr))
8506 addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, op0);
8508 op0 = change_address (op0, V4SImode, addr);
8509 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8510 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8511 if (! pat)
8512 return 0;
8514 emit_insn (pat);
8515 return 0;
8518 /* Expand builtins that take two long operands and return void. */
8520 static rtx
8521 frv_expand_int_void2arg (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8523 rtx pat;
8524 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8525 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8527 op0 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op0);
8528 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8529 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8530 if (! pat)
8531 return NULL_RTX;
8533 emit_insn (pat);
8534 return NULL_RTX;
8537 /* Expand prefetch builtins. These take a single address as argument. */
8539 static rtx
8540 frv_expand_prefetches (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8542 rtx pat;
8543 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8545 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (force_reg (Pmode, op0));
8546 if (! pat)
8547 return 0;
8549 emit_insn (pat);
8550 return 0;
8553 /* Expand builtins that take three operands and return void. The first
8554 argument must be a constant that describes a pair or quad accumulators. A
8555 fourth argument is created that is the accumulator guard register that
8556 corresponds to the accumulator. */
8558 static rtx
8559 frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8561 rtx pat;
8562 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8563 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8564 rtx op2 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8565 rtx op3;
8567 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
8568 if (! op0)
8569 return NULL_RTX;
8571 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8572 op2 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 2, op2);
8573 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8574 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
8575 if (! pat)
8576 return NULL_RTX;
8578 emit_insn (pat);
8579 return NULL_RTX;
8582 /* Expand builtins that perform accumulator-to-accumulator operations.
8583 These builtins take two accumulator numbers as argument and return
8584 void. */
8586 static rtx
8587 frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8589 rtx pat;
8590 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8591 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8592 rtx op2;
8593 rtx op3;
8595 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
8596 if (! op0)
8597 return NULL_RTX;
8599 op1 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op1);
8600 if (! op1)
8601 return NULL_RTX;
8603 op2 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op0);
8604 op3 = frv_matching_accg_for_acc (op1);
8605 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1, op2, op3);
8606 if (! pat)
8607 return NULL_RTX;
8609 emit_insn (pat);
8610 return NULL_RTX;
8613 /* Expand the MDPACKH builtin. It takes four unsigned short arguments and
8614 each argument forms one word of the two double-word input registers.
8615 ARGLIST is a TREE_LIST of the arguments and TARGET, if nonnull,
8616 suggests a good place to put the return value. */
8618 static rtx
8619 frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (tree arglist, rtx target)
8621 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mdpackh;
8622 rtx pat, op0, op1;
8623 rtx arg1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8624 rtx arg2 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8625 rtx arg3 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8626 rtx arg4 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8628 target = frv_legitimize_target (icode, target);
8629 op0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
8630 op1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
8632 /* The high half of each word is not explicitly initialized, so indicate
8633 that the input operands are not live before this point. */
8634 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (DImode, op0));
8635 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (DImode, op1));
8637 /* Move each argument into the low half of its associated input word. */
8638 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 2), arg1);
8639 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op0, DImode, 6), arg2);
8640 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 2), arg3);
8641 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (HImode, op1, DImode, 6), arg4);
8643 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
8644 if (! pat)
8645 return NULL_RTX;
8647 emit_insn (pat);
8648 return target;
8651 /* Expand the MCLRACC builtin. This builtin takes a single accumulator
8652 number as argument. */
8654 static rtx
8655 frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (tree arglist)
8657 enum insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_mclracc;
8658 rtx pat;
8659 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8661 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
8662 if (! op0)
8663 return NULL_RTX;
8665 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0);
8666 if (pat)
8667 emit_insn (pat);
8669 return NULL_RTX;
8672 /* Expand builtins that take no arguments. */
8674 static rtx
8675 frv_expand_noargs_builtin (enum insn_code icode)
8677 rtx pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (const0_rtx);
8678 if (pat)
8679 emit_insn (pat);
8681 return NULL_RTX;
8684 /* Expand MRDACC and MRDACCG. These builtins take a single accumulator
8685 number or accumulator guard number as argument and return an SI integer. */
8687 static rtx
8688 frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8690 rtx pat;
8691 rtx target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
8692 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8694 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 1, op0);
8695 if (! op0)
8696 return NULL_RTX;
8698 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
8699 if (! pat)
8700 return NULL_RTX;
8702 emit_insn (pat);
8703 return target;
8706 /* Expand MWTACC and MWTACCG. These builtins take an accumulator or
8707 accumulator guard as their first argument and an SImode value as their
8708 second. */
8710 static rtx
8711 frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (enum insn_code icode, tree arglist)
8713 rtx pat;
8714 rtx op0 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8715 rtx op1 = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8717 op0 = frv_int_to_acc (icode, 0, op0);
8718 if (! op0)
8719 return NULL_RTX;
8721 op1 = frv_legitimize_argument (icode, 1, op1);
8722 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op0, op1);
8723 if (pat)
8724 emit_insn (pat);
8726 return NULL_RTX;
8729 /* Emit a move from SRC to DEST in SImode chunks. This can be used
8730 to move DImode values into and out of IACC0. */
8732 static void
8733 frv_split_iacc_move (rtx dest, rtx src)
8735 enum machine_mode inner;
8736 int i;
8738 inner = GET_MODE (dest);
8739 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (inner); i += GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode))
8740 emit_move_insn (simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, dest, inner, i),
8741 simplify_gen_subreg (SImode, src, inner, i));
8744 /* Expand builtins. */
8746 static rtx
8747 frv_expand_builtin (tree exp,
8748 rtx target,
8749 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8750 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8751 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8753 tree arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8754 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
8755 unsigned fcode = (unsigned)DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
8756 unsigned i;
8757 struct builtin_description *d;
8759 if (fcode < FRV_BUILTIN_FIRST_NONMEDIA && !TARGET_MEDIA)
8761 error ("media functions are not available unless -mmedia is used");
8762 return NULL_RTX;
8765 switch (fcode)
8767 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP1:
8768 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCOP2:
8769 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDUNPACKH:
8770 case FRV_BUILTIN_MBTOHE:
8771 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV1)
8773 error ("this media function is only available on the fr500");
8774 return NULL_RTX;
8776 break;
8778 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACHS:
8779 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQXMACXHS:
8780 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQMACXHS:
8781 case FRV_BUILTIN_MADDACCS:
8782 case FRV_BUILTIN_MSUBACCS:
8783 case FRV_BUILTIN_MASACCS:
8784 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDADDACCS:
8785 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDSUBACCS:
8786 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDASACCS:
8787 case FRV_BUILTIN_MABSHS:
8788 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDROTLI:
8789 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLHI:
8790 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCPLI:
8791 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDCUTSSI:
8792 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSATHS:
8793 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOS:
8794 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETLOH:
8795 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIS:
8796 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHSETHIH:
8797 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETS:
8798 case FRV_BUILTIN_MHDSETH:
8799 if (! TARGET_MEDIA_REV2)
8801 error ("this media function is only available on the fr400"
8802 " and fr550");
8803 return NULL_RTX;
8805 break;
8807 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMASS:
8808 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMSSS:
8809 case FRV_BUILTIN_SMU:
8810 case FRV_BUILTIN_ADDSS:
8811 case FRV_BUILTIN_SUBSS:
8812 case FRV_BUILTIN_SLASS:
8813 case FRV_BUILTIN_SCUTSS:
8814 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
8815 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
8816 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
8817 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
8818 if (!TARGET_FR405_BUILTINS)
8820 error ("this builtin function is only available"
8821 " on the fr405 and fr450");
8822 return NULL_RTX;
8824 break;
8826 case FRV_BUILTIN_PREFETCH:
8827 if (!TARGET_FR500_FR550_BUILTINS)
8829 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr500"
8830 " and fr550");
8831 return NULL_RTX;
8833 break;
8835 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLCLRHS:
8836 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQLMTHS:
8837 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSLLHI:
8838 case FRV_BUILTIN_MQSRAHI:
8839 if (!TARGET_MEDIA_FR450)
8841 error ("this builtin function is only available on the fr450");
8842 return NULL_RTX;
8844 break;
8846 default:
8847 break;
8850 /* Expand unique builtins. */
8852 switch (fcode)
8854 case FRV_BUILTIN_MTRAP:
8855 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mtrap);
8857 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACC:
8858 return frv_expand_mclracc_builtin (arglist);
8860 case FRV_BUILTIN_MCLRACCA:
8861 if (TARGET_ACC_8)
8862 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca8);
8863 else
8864 return frv_expand_noargs_builtin (CODE_FOR_mclracca4);
8866 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACC:
8867 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdacc, arglist);
8869 case FRV_BUILTIN_MRDACCG:
8870 return frv_expand_mrdacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mrdaccg, arglist);
8872 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACC:
8873 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtacc, arglist);
8875 case FRV_BUILTIN_MWTACCG:
8876 return frv_expand_mwtacc_builtin (CODE_FOR_mwtaccg, arglist);
8878 case FRV_BUILTIN_MDPACKH:
8879 return frv_expand_mdpackh_builtin (arglist, target);
8881 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadll:
8883 rtx src = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, &arglist);
8884 if (target == 0 || !REG_P (target))
8885 target = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
8886 frv_split_iacc_move (target, src);
8887 return target;
8890 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCreadl:
8891 return frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, &arglist);
8893 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetll:
8895 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (DImode, &arglist);
8896 rtx src = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8897 frv_split_iacc_move (dest, force_reg (DImode, src));
8898 return 0;
8901 case FRV_BUILTIN_IACCsetl:
8903 rtx dest = frv_read_iacc_argument (SImode, &arglist);
8904 rtx src = frv_read_argument (&arglist);
8905 emit_move_insn (dest, force_reg (SImode, src));
8906 return 0;
8909 default:
8910 break;
8913 /* Expand groups of builtins. */
8915 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_set; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_set); i++, d++)
8916 if (d->code == fcode)
8917 return frv_expand_set_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
8919 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_1arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_1arg); i++, d++)
8920 if (d->code == fcode)
8921 return frv_expand_unop_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
8923 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
8924 if (d->code == fcode)
8925 return frv_expand_binop_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
8927 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_cut; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_cut); i++, d++)
8928 if (d->code == fcode)
8929 return frv_expand_cut_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
8931 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2argimm; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2argimm); i++, d++)
8932 if (d->code == fcode)
8933 return frv_expand_binopimm_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
8935 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void2arg); i++, d++)
8936 if (d->code == fcode)
8937 return frv_expand_voidbinop_builtin (d->icode, arglist);
8939 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_void3arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_void3arg); i++, d++)
8940 if (d->code == fcode)
8941 return frv_expand_voidtriop_builtin (d->icode, arglist);
8943 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_voidacc; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_voidacc); i++, d++)
8944 if (d->code == fcode)
8945 return frv_expand_voidaccop_builtin (d->icode, arglist);
8947 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_int_void2arg;
8948 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_int_void2arg); i++, d++)
8949 if (d->code == fcode)
8950 return frv_expand_int_void2arg (d->icode, arglist);
8952 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_prefetches;
8953 i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_prefetches); i++, d++)
8954 if (d->code == fcode)
8955 return frv_expand_prefetches (d->icode, arglist);
8957 return 0;
8960 static bool
8961 frv_in_small_data_p (tree decl)
8963 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
8964 tree section_name;
8966 /* Don't apply the -G flag to internal compiler structures. We
8967 should leave such structures in the main data section, partly
8968 for efficiency and partly because the size of some of them
8969 (such as C++ typeinfos) is not known until later. */
8970 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
8971 return false;
8973 /* If we already know which section the decl should be in, see if
8974 it's a small data section. */
8975 section_name = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
8976 if (section_name)
8978 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (section_name) == STRING_CST);
8979 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sdata"))
8980 return true;
8981 if (frv_string_begins_with (section_name, ".sbss"))
8982 return true;
8983 return false;
8986 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (decl));
8987 if (size > 0 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) size <= g_switch_value)
8988 return true;
8990 return false;
8993 static bool
8994 frv_rtx_costs (rtx x,
8995 int code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8996 int outer_code ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8997 int *total)
8999 if (outer_code == MEM)
9001 /* Don't differentiate between memory addresses. All the ones
9002 we accept have equal cost. */
9003 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (0);
9004 return true;
9007 switch (code)
9009 case CONST_INT:
9010 /* Make 12 bit integers really cheap. */
9011 if (IN_RANGE_P (INTVAL (x), -2048, 2047))
9013 *total = 0;
9014 return true;
9016 /* Fall through. */
9018 case CONST:
9019 case LABEL_REF:
9020 case SYMBOL_REF:
9021 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9022 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9023 return true;
9025 case PLUS:
9026 case MINUS:
9027 case AND:
9028 case IOR:
9029 case XOR:
9030 case ASHIFT:
9031 case ASHIFTRT:
9032 case LSHIFTRT:
9033 case NOT:
9034 case NEG:
9035 case COMPARE:
9036 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9037 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
9038 else if (GET_MODE (x) == DImode)
9039 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9040 else
9041 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9042 return true;
9044 case MULT:
9045 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode)
9046 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
9047 else
9048 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (6); /* guess */
9049 return true;
9051 case DIV:
9052 case UDIV:
9053 case MOD:
9054 case UMOD:
9055 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (18);
9056 return true;
9058 case MEM:
9059 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
9060 return true;
9062 default:
9063 return false;
9067 static void
9068 frv_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9070 ctors_section ();
9071 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9072 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9074 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9076 gcc_assert (ok);
9077 return;
9079 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9082 static void
9083 frv_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9085 dtors_section ();
9086 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
9087 if (TARGET_FDPIC)
9089 int ok = frv_assemble_integer (symbol, POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
9091 gcc_assert (ok);
9092 return;
9094 assemble_integer_with_op ("\t.picptr\t", symbol);
9097 /* Worker function for TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX. */
9099 static rtx
9100 frv_struct_value_rtx (tree fntype ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9101 int incoming ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9103 return gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, FRV_STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM);
9106 #define TLS_BIAS (2048 - 16)
9108 /* This is called from dwarf2out.c via TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL.
9109 We need to emit DTP-relative relocations. */
9111 static void
9112 frv_output_dwarf_dtprel (FILE *file, int size, rtx x)
9114 gcc_assert (size == 4);
9115 fputs ("\t.picptr\ttlsmoff(", file);
9116 /* We want the unbiased TLS offset, so add the bias to the
9117 expression, such that the implicit biasing cancels out. */
9118 output_addr_const (file, plus_constant (x, TLS_BIAS));
9119 fputs (")", file);
9122 #include "gt-frv.h"